Académique Documents
Professionnel Documents
Culture Documents
V100R011C10
Issue
01
Date
2015-12-30
Notice
The purchased products, services and features are stipulated by the contract made between Huawei and
the customer. All or part of the products, services and features described in this document may not be
within the purchase scope or the usage scope. Unless otherwise specified in the contract, all statements,
information, and recommendations in this document are provided "AS IS" without warranties, guarantees
or representations of any kind, either express or implied.
The information in this document is subject to change without notice. Every effort has been made in the
preparation of this document to ensure accuracy of the contents, but all statements, information, and
recommendations in this document do not constitute a warranty of any kind, express or implied.
Website:
http://www.huawei.com
Email:
support@huawei.com
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Contents
Contents
1 Overview...................................................................................... 1
1.1 About This Document.....................................................................................................................................................1
1.2 Prerequisites...................................................................................................................................................................1
2 Mode Transition............................................................................2
3 Planning Mode Transition..............................................................5
3.1 Introduction....................................................................................................................................................................5
3.2 RF Planning....................................................................................................................................................................6
3.2.1 Overall RF Planning Process.......................................................................................................................................6
3.2.2 Adding an RF Module.................................................................................................................................................7
3.2.3 Reusing the Original Multiband Module...................................................................................................................12
3.2.4 Applying SDR to the Original RF Module................................................................................................................15
3.2.5 Adding a Module to the Original SDR Module.........................................................................................................20
3.2.6 Replacing the Original Module with a New SDR Module........................................................................................26
3.3 Antenna and Feeder Networking..................................................................................................................................32
3.3.1 Overall Antenna and Feeder Planning Process..........................................................................................................32
3.3.2 Adding an Independent Antenna (Antenna Port) and an Independent Feeder..........................................................33
3.3.3 Adding an Independent Antenna (Antenna Port) and Sharing the Original Feeder..................................................44
3.3.4 Broadband Antenna (Antenna Port) Being Shared By the Original Mode and New Mode......................................55
3.3.5 SDR RF Module of the New Mode Using the Original Feeder................................................................................58
3.4 Co-MPT or Separate-MPT Planning............................................................................................................................59
3.4.1 Overall Co-MPT or Separate-MPT Planning Process...............................................................................................59
3.4.2 Adding a Main Control Board of the New Mode to the Original BBU....................................................................61
3.4.3 Adding a new BBU and a Main Control Board of the New Mode............................................................................65
3.4.4 Adding a New Mode to the Co-MPT Base Station...................................................................................................67
3.4.5 Co-MPT Reconstruction and Adding a New Mode to the Co-MPT Base Station....................................................69
3.5 BBU Interconnection....................................................................................................................................................87
3.5.1 Overall BBU Interconnection Planning Process.......................................................................................................87
3.5.2 Adding a BBU for BBU Interconnection Through UCIU+UMPT...........................................................................89
3.5.3 Adding a BBU for BBU Interconnection Through UMPT+UMPT..........................................................................93
3.6 Clock Planning.............................................................................................................................................................96
3.6.1 Overall Clock Planning Process................................................................................................................................96
3.6.2 New Mode Using an Independent Reference Clock with Separate-MPT Configuration..........................................98
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
ii
Contents
3.6.3 New Mode and Original Mode Sharing Reference Clock with Separate-MPT Configuration.................................99
3.6.4 New Mode Requiring Modification to the Clock Source with Co-MPT Configuration.........................................100
3.7 Baseband Planning.....................................................................................................................................................102
3.7.1 Overall Baseband Planning Process........................................................................................................................103
3.7.2 Adding an Independent Baseband Board to the New Mode with Separate-MPT Configuration............................104
3.7.3 Adding an Independent Baseband Processing Board to the New Mode with Co-MPT Configuration...................106
3.7.4 Adding a New Mode to the Original Baseband Processing Board with Co-MPT Configuration...........................108
3.8 CPRI-based Topology Planning.................................................................................................................................110
3.8.1 Overall CPRI-based Topology Planning.................................................................................................................110
3.8.2 Chain Topology for RF Modules.............................................................................................................................111
3.8.3 Dual-Star Topology (Load Sharing) for SDR RF Modules.....................................................................................114
3.8.4 CPRI MUX for SDR RF Modules...........................................................................................................................118
3.9 Transmission Networking Planning...........................................................................................................................121
3.9.1 Transmission Networking Planning Process...........................................................................................................122
3.9.2 New Mode Using Independent Transmission with Separate-MPT Configuration..................................................124
3.9.3 New Mode Using the Transmission Port Provided by the Original Mode with Separate-MPT Configuration......126
3.9.4 New Mode Providing a Transmission Port Shared by the Original Mode with Separate-MPT Configuration......128
3.9.5 Co-Transmission for New and Original Modes with co-MPT Configuration.........................................................131
3.10 Equipment Auxiliary Planning.................................................................................................................................134
3.11 Summary of Mode Transition Planning....................................................................................................................140
3.11.1 License File Requirement......................................................................................................................................140
3.11.2 NE Software Version Requirement........................................................................................................................154
3.11.3 Board and Cable Installation Requirement............................................................................................................154
3.11.4 Data Configuration Requirement...........................................................................................................................157
3.11.5 Tool Requirements for Co-MPT Reconstruction...................................................................................................163
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
iii
Contents
iv
Contents
7.6.2.2 Co-MPT................................................................................................................................................................313
7.6.3 Preparing Radio Data..............................................................................................................................................313
7.6.3.1 Separate-MPT.......................................................................................................................................................313
7.6.3.2 Co-MPT................................................................................................................................................................314
7.6.4 Adjusting Transmission, Equipment, Radio Data (LTE Only)................................................................................314
7.6.4.1 Separate-MPT.......................................................................................................................................................315
7.6.4.2 Co-MPT................................................................................................................................................................315
7.6.5 Adjusting Transmission, Equipment, Radio Data (FDD+TDD).............................................................................315
7.7 Binding Base Station Multimode Relationships.........................................................................................................317
7.8 Checking MBTS Data Consistency............................................................................................................................318
7.9 Checking Data Preparations.......................................................................................................................................318
Contents
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
vi
1 Overview
Overview
1.2 Prerequisites
None.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
2 Mode Transition
Mode Transition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
2 Mode Transition
Item
Operation
Preparation
Implementation
Upgrading software
Recording related
information
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Adjusting hardware
Phase
Verification
2 Mode Transition
Item
Operation
Activating configuration
data
operations in parallel to
shorten the service
interruption duration.
Commissioning base
stations
Outputting engineering
reports
Checking engineering
quality and conduct a
dialing test if no major
changes are made to the
main control board and
transmission scheme.
The NEP-SD tool can be used to analyze mode transition planning and design and prepare
configuration data. For details, see NEP-SD-Based Wireless Base Station Design Guidelines.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
This section describes the mode transition planning in terms of the radio frequency (RF),
antenna and feeder networking, co-MPT or separate-MPT, BBU interconnection, clock,
baseband, CPRI-based topologies, transmission, and equipment auxiliary.
3.1 Introduction
The base station system mainly consists of subsystems and other items shown in the following
figure: antennas, radio frequency (RF), CPRI cables, and others.
The following sections will cover planning operations for all these items and mode transition
requirements for the material, version, and others.
The following figure describes the constraints of these subsystems and other items on each
other.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Solid lines with arrows indicate the dependent objects and dotted lines with arrows point to
further information of specific objects.
Figure 1.1 Constraints of the subsystems and other items on each other
3.2 RF Planning
This section describes RF planning.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Check whether the original multiband module supports the new frequency band.
Check whether the original multiband module supports the specifications after mode
transition.
This is determined based on the following items that have been planned by the customer:
mode, number of TRXs, power, TRX frequency, and numbers of RX and TX channels.
For details, see the RF module and RF Configuration & Output power sheets in
SingleRAN Multi-mode BTS Product Specification.
Check whether the original multiband module supports the specifications after
refarming.
This is determined based on the following items that have been planned by the customer:
mode, number of TRXs, power, TRX frequency, and numbers of RX and TX channels.
For details, see the RF module and RF Configuration & Output power sheets in
SingleRAN Multi-mode BTS Product Specification.
Table 1.1 Scenario analysis
Categor
y
New
Band/Refa
rming
Scenario
RF module
New band
Adding an RF Module
Reusing the Original MultiBand Module
Refarming
3. Engineering guidelines
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
RF module
See
SRAN&GBSS&RAN
&eRAN BTS3900
Configuration
Manual.
CPRI high-speed
cable
CPRI fiber optic
cable
Optical module
RF interconnection
cable
Required by the
GSM, multimode,
and UMTS RF
modules
For the mapping relationship between the RF modules and versions, see 3900 Series Base
Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
To support the new mode, the hardware license of this mode must be purchased for the new
RF module, such as the power license and TRX license. The way of purchasing such a license
is the same as that for a single-mode RF module, and therefore details are not described here.
For a multiband RF module (except the RRU3961), one multimode multiband license is
required for each frequency band of each mode (GSM, UMTS, or LTE).
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Mode
82205398
LQW9RFB
Per band
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205382
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205382
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
AND01
For the RRU3961, the RF 800 MHz/900 MHz multiband license must be purchased if the
RRU3961 works on both the 800 MHz and 900 MHz frequency bands.
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
RF 800M/900M
Multi Band license
RF
800M/900M
Multi Band
license
82204034
LLT1RFM
B01
Per
band
per
RRU
For the RRU3961 and single-band module, the RF multimode license corresponding to each
mode must be purchased if SDR is used on one frequency band.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sale
s
Unit
Mo
de
GU
Non-blade
module
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBT
SRF02
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBT
SRF02
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM
01
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM
01
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM
01
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM
01
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
sector
U+
L
GL
UL
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
10
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sale
s
Unit
Mo
de
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
sector
U+
L
license
or
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
Blade&A
AU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+ GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
or
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
Data configuration for adding an RF module is the same as that in single-mode scenarios.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
Guidelines:
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (Multimode Base
Station)" of RF Unit and Topology Management Feature Parameter Description.
Pay attention to the following during data configuration:
- Determine the CPRI-based topology according to topology types supported by an RF
module in multimode scenarios.
- Configure the working mode of an RF unit according to the live network deployment.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
11
Determine the parameters and their values to be configured according to the guide and specify
them in the following table. The following table provides the major eGBTS/UMTS/LTE
parameters and their value examples. The BTSTRXBRD MOC is for the GBTS.
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
RF module
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Cabinet
No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Subrack
No.
SRN
60
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Rin
g No.
RCN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Position
PS
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
RX
channels
RXNUM
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
TX
channels
TXNUM
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
12
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
RF module
Determine whether
to add a fiber optic
cable based on the
CPRI-based
topology.
Optical module
Determine whether
to add a fiber optic
cable based on the
CPRI-based
topology.
For the mapping relationship between the baseband processing boards and versions, see GUL
Base Station Overview and Selection Guide.
To support the new mode, the hardware license of this mode must be purchased for the new
RF module, such as the power license and TRX license. The way of purchasing such a license
is the same as that for a single-mode RF module, and therefore, details are not described here.
For a multiband RF module (except the RRU3961), one multimode multiband license is
required for each frequency band of each mode (GSM, UMTS, or LTE).
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per band
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
13
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per band
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
For the RRU3961, the RF 800 MHz/900 MHz multiband license must be purchased if the
RRU3961 works on both the 800 MHz and 900 MHz frequency bands.
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
RF 800M/900M
Multi Band license
RF
800M/900M
Multi Band
license
82204034
LLT1RFM
B01
Per
band
per
RRU
Data configuration for adding an RF module is the same as that in single-mode scenarios.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
14
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (Multimode Base
Station)" of RF Unit and Topology Management Feature Parameter Description.
Pay attention to the following during data configuration:
- Configure the working mode of an RF unit according to the live network deployment.
- Configure sector equipment parameters according to the type of a multiband module:
sharing the same DIN connector or using different DIN connectors.
Determine the parameters and their values to be configured according to the guide and specify
them in the following table. The following table provides the major eGBTS/UMTS/LTE
parameters and their value examples. The BTSTRXBRD MOC is for the GBTS.
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
RF module
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Cabinet
No.
CN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Subrack
No.
SRN
60
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Rin
g No.
RCN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU
Position
PS
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Number of
RX
channels
RXNUM
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Number of
TX
channels
TXNUM
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Service impact
15
Scenario
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
RF module
Determine whether
to add a fiber optic
cable based on the
CPRI-based
topology.
Optical module
Determine whether
to add a fiber optic
cable based on the
CPRI-based
topology.
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the RF modules and versions, see GUL Base Station
Overview and Selection Guide.
License requirement
To support the new mode, the hardware license of this mode must be purchased for the new
RF module, such as the power license and TRX license. The way of purchasing such a license
is the same as that for a single-mode RF module, and therefore, details are not described here.
For a multiband RF module (except the RRU3961), one multimode multiband license is
required for each frequency band of each mode (GSM, UMTS, or LTE).
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
First Mode
First Band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
82205398
LQW9RFB
Per band
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
16
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
(Per Band
per RRU)
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per band
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per band
AND01
For the RRU3961, the RF 800 MHz/900 MHz multiband license must be purchased if the
RRU3961 works on both the 800 MHz and 900 MHz frequency bands.
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
RF 800M/900M
Multi Band license
RF
800M/900M
Multi Band
license
82204034
LLT1RFM
B01
Per
band
per
RRU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
17
For the RRU3961 and single-band module, the RF multimode license corresponding to each
mode must be purchased if SDR is used on one frequency band.
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sale
s
Unit
Mo
de
GU
Non-blade
module
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBT
SRF02
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBT
SRF02
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM
01
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM
01
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM
01
Per
sector
Blade&A
AU
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM
01
Per
sector
Non-blade
module
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
sector
U+
L
GL
UL
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
18
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sale
s
Unit
Mo
de
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
sector
U+
L
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
or
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
Blade&A
AU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+ GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
or
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
Original mode:
The original working mode of the RF module must be changed.
New mode:
Data configuration is the same as that for adding an RF module. Note that the working mode
of the RF module must be correctly configured.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (Multimode Base
Station)" of RF Unit and Topology Management Feature Parameter Description.
Pay attention to the following during data configuration:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
19
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
RF module
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Cabinet
No.
CN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Subrack
No.
SRN
60
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Rin
g No.
RCN
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RRU
Position
PS
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Number of
RX
channels
RXNUM
Modifying
an RXU
RRU
Number of
TX
channels
TXNUM
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
20
Scenario
or V2 RF module.
RF modules of the same type are preferred for capacity expansion in the same cell.
If the original module is end of marketing (EOM) or cannot meet capacity requirements
after mode transition, modules of different types can be configured together. For details,
see GUL RF Module Mixed Configuration Guide.
2. Precautions
Pay attention to the mapping relationship between the added module and cabinet:
The maximum transmit power of an RFU varies by RFU model. Greater RFU's transmit
power indicates higher requirements for power distribution and heat dissipation of the
cabinet. Therefore, RFUs of small power can work with all cabinets while RFUs of large
power can work only with Ver.C cabinets, Ver.D cabinets (or the ones has equivalent
capabilities after upgrade), and the BTS3900AL (Ver.A) cabinets.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
RRU/RFU
See
SRAN&GBSS&RAN
&eRAN BTS3900
Configuration
Manual.
CPRI high-speed
cable
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Optical module
21
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
RRU power cable if
it cannot be reused.
RF interconnection
cable
Required by the
GSM, multimode,
and UMTS RF
modules
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the RF modules and versions, see GUL Base Station
Overview and Selection Guide.
License requirement
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module
(UMTS) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per
band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module
(UMTS) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per
band
Multi-Mode
82205382
LLT1MML
Per
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
22
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module (LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per RRU)
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module (LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per RRU)
License
BBOM
82205382
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
MBRM01
band
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per
band
Mod
e
For the RRU3961, the RF 800 MHz/900 MHz multiband license must be purchased if the
RRU3961 works on both the 800 MHz and 900 MHz frequency bands.
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
RF 800M/900M
Multi Band license
RF
800M/900M
Multi Band
license
82204034
LLT1RFM
B01
Per
band
per
RRU
For the RRU3961 and single-band module, the RF multimode license corresponding to each
mode must be purchased if SDR is used on one frequency band.
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbreviati
on
Sal
es
Un
it
Mo
de
GU
Non-blade
module
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBTSR
F02
Per
sect
or
Blade&A
GSM/UMTS
The
822011
LQW9MBTSR
Per
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
23
Sc
en
ari
o
GL
UL
GU
L
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbreviati
on
Sal
es
Un
it
Mo
de
AU
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
99
F02
sect
or
Non-blade
module
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(pe
r Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM01
Per
sect
or
Blade&A
AU
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(pe
r Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM01
Per
sect
or
Non-blade
module
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(pe
r Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM01
Per
sect
or
Blade&A
AU
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(pe
r Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM01
Per
sect
or
Non-blade
module
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
sect
or
U+
L
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
U+
or
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
Blade&A
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
GSM/UMTS
24
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
AU
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+ GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbreviati
on
Sal
es
Un
it
Mo
de
sect
or
or
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
Original mode:
TRX configuration of the original mode may be changed, such as a decrease in the TRX
number due to refarming and changes in RF channels of TRXs).
New mode:
Data configuration is the same as that for adding an RF module. Note that the working mode
of the RF module must be correctly configured.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (Multimode Base
Station)" of RF Unit and Topology Management Feature Parameter Description.
Pay attention to the following during data configuration:
- Determine the CPRI-based topology according to topology types supported by an RF
module in multimode scenarios.
- Configure the working mode of an RF unit according to the live network deployment.
Determine the parameters and their values to be configured according to the guide and specify
them in the following table. The following table provides the major eGBTS/UMTS/LTE
parameters and their value examples. The BTSTRXBRD MOC is for the GBTS.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
25
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
RF module
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Cabinet
No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Subrack
No.
SRN
60
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Rin
g No.
RCN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Position
PS
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
RX
channels
RXNUM
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
TX
channels
TXNUM
Service impact
Scenario
26
Mode, frequency band, number of TRXs, power, TRX frequencies, and numbers of RX and
TX channels that have been planned by the customer.
For details about the selection, see GUL Base Station Overview and Selection Guide.
2. Precautions
Pay attention to the following items when replacing the original RF module:
Whether the RRU power cable of the original RF module shall be replaced
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
RRU/RFU
Determined based
on the plan
CPRI high-speed
cable
Optical module
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the RF modules and versions, see GUL Base Station
Overview and Selection Guide.
License requirement
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
27
To support the new mode, the hardware license of this mode must be purchased for the new
RF module, such as the power license and TRX license. The way of purchasing such a license
is the same as that for a single-mode RF module, and therefore, details are not described here.
Multimode RF license
For a multiband RF module (except the RRU3961), one multimode multiband license is
required for each frequency band of each mode (GSM, UMTS, or LTE).
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module
(UMTS) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per
band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module
(UMTS) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RFB
AND01
Per
band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module (LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per
band
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band RF
Module (LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per RRU)
82205382
LLT1MML
MBRM01
Per
band
For the RRU3961, the RF 800 MHz/900 MHz multiband license must be purchased if the
RRU3961 works on both the 800 MHz and 900 MHz frequency bands.
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
Mod
e
RF 800M/900M
RF
82204034
LLT1RFM
Per
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
28
License Control
Item Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item Name
(BBOM)
800M/900M
Multi Band
license
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sale
s
Unit
B01
band
per
RRU
Mod
e
If SDR is used on a band, the related RF multimode license of the mode shall be purchased.
Sc
en
ari
o
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbreviat
ion
Sal
es
Uni
t
Mo
de
GU
Non-blade
module
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBTS
RF02
Per
secto
r
Blade and
AAU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
822011
99
LQW9MBTS
RF02
Per
secto
r
Non-blade
module
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM0
1
Per
secto
r
Blade and
AAU
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
GSM/LTE
Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
72
LLT1GLDM0
1
Per
secto
r
Non-blade
module
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM0
1
Per
secto
r
GL
UL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
29
Sc
en
ari
o
GU
L
Module
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
Licen
se
BBO
M
License
Abbreviat
ion
Sal
es
Uni
t
Mo
de
Blade and
AAU
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
822014
73
LLT1ULDM0
1
Per
secto
r
Non-blade
module
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
secto
r
U+
L
N/A
N/A
N/A
Per
secto
r
U+
L
or
RF
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license + RF
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
Blade and
AAU
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+ GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
or
GSM/UMTS
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
+ UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AAU
Original mode:
TRX configuration of the original mode may be changed, such as a decrease in the TRX
number due to refarming and changes in RF channels of TRXs).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
30
New mode:
Data configuration is the same as that for adding an RF module. Note that the working mode
of the RF module must be correctly configured.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (Multimode Base
Station)" of RF Unit and Topology Management Feature Parameter Description.
Pay attention to the following during data configuration:
- Determine the CPRI-based topology according to topology types supported by an RF
module in multimode scenarios.
- Configure the working mode of an RF unit according to the live network deployment.
- Set the RXUSPEC parameter to the name of the new RF module for the GBTS. The
RUSPEC parameter is optional for the eGBTS, NodeB, and eNodeB.
Determine the parameters and their values to be configured according to the guide and specify
them in the following table. The following table provides the major eGBTS/UMTS/LTE
parameters and their value examples. The BTSTRXBRD MOC is for the GBTS.
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
RF module
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Cabinet
No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Subrack
No.
SRN
60
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Rin
g No.
RCN
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Position
PS
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
RX
channels
RXNUM
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
TX
TXNUM
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
31
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Paramete
r ID
Value
(Example)
channels
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
32
Check whether the original antenna supports the new frequency band.
In this step, obtain the antenna model so that you can find the datasheet of the original
antenna.
33
Check whether the new and original frequency bands share the same antenna port.
In this step, obtain the antenna model so that you can find the datasheet of the original
antenna.
The datasheet indicates whether the original antenna port supports the broadband antenna. If
the broadband antenna is supported, the new and original frequency bands can share the same
antenna port.
Note that if the original and new RF modules work on independent frequency bands, an
external inter-band combiner must be added for combing the original and new frequency
bands so that the two RF modules can share the same antenna port.
Generally, broadband antennas share the same port, and therefore two frequency bands on
these antennas do not support independent remote electrical tilt (RET).
Table 1.1 Analysis of antenna and feeder planning scenarios
Catego
ry
RF
modul
e
Scenario
Antenna
and
feeder
networki
ng
New
mode
only
SDR RF
module
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
34
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
35
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
36
In this scenario of mode transition, an RF module working on the new frequency band uses an
independent set of antenna and feeder. In such a case, you can use an independent antenna or
reuse the original multiband multi-port antenna. In addition, customers may replace the
original antenna with a multiband multi-port antenna due to constraints on site conditions.
This scenario has the following characteristics:
If an RET antenna is used, independent RET and electrical tilt configuration are
supported.
If an independent antenna is used, you can independently set the mechanical tilt.
2. Precautions
In scenarios of adding an RET or TMA, check the model, and hardware and software
versions of RET or TMA for compatibility. For details, contact Global Technical
Assistance Center (GTAC) or Technical Management Office (TMO) teams. A list of RET
or TMA models that have passed the interoperability test (IOT) compatibility test is
available. If the RET or TMA to be added is not included in the list, relevant tests by
R&D or field engineers are recommended.
Pay attention to frequency bands supported by the TMA, especially the reused TMA.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
37
The RRU is directly connected to the RET through an RET port. Only AISG cables
delivered by Huawei can be used and special attention shall be paid to cable and length
constraints.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Antenna
Feeder
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Jumper
SBT
Required on the
antenna side when
the following
conditions are met:
RET is configured
for the new
mode.
No TMA is
configured.
TMA
Configured as
required by the
network plan.
RCU
38
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
available.
Required for
connecting to the
SBT or TMA when
RET is required. The
lengths of the AISG
cable vary with
scenarios.
Version requirement
None
License requirement
The GSM and UMTS systems have no requirements for deploying this feature.
The feature license must be purchased when RET is used for LTE. The following table
provides the related license control items.
Table 3.2 License control items for optional features of RET management
Feature Name
License Control
Item
License
Abbreviation
(LTE-FDD) LOFD-001024
Remote Electrical Tilt Control
LLT1RET01
(LTE-TDD) TDLOFD-001024
Remote Electrical Tilt Control
LLT1RET01
Data configuration for a multimode antenna is the same as that for a set of single-mode
antenna.
Key points for the data configuration are listed as follows:
- Based on connections of the RFU/RRU, antenna, and feeder, configure RF transmit and
receive mode for the GBTS, and TxBranch/RxBranch/RFCONNGRP information about the
RF module for the eGBTS, NodeB, eNodeB, and co-MPT base station.
- If RET is required, configure the ALD power supply switch for the RRU or RFU and related
alarm threshold parameters. ALD is short for antenna line device. In addition, configure RET
for the RET antenna, download the RET configuration file, calibrate the RET antenna, and set
tilt angels.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
39
- If a TMA is required, configure the TMA and TMA attenuation corresponding to the RRU or
RFU's channel.
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (ALD Manual
Deployment on Multimode Base Station)" of ALD Management Feature Parameter
Description.
Examples:
The following table describes the key parameters that must be set when RET is controlled by
the RRU or RFU through its RETPORT.
Table 3.3 Key parameters related to the RETPORT
Domai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Param
eter ID
Example
Value
Antenna
and
feeder
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Cabinet No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Subrack No.
SRN
62
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Port No.
PN
RET_PORT
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
ALD Power
Switch
PWRSWI
TCH
ON
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Current Alarm
Threshold
THRESH
OLDTYP
E
UER_SELF_DEF
INE
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Undercurrent
Alarm Occur
Threshold
UOTHD
40
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Undercurrent
Alarm Clear
Threshold
UCTHD
60
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Overcurrent
Alarm Occur
Threshold
OOTHD
850
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Overcurrent
Alarm Clear
Threshold
OCTHD
750
The following table describes the key parameters that must be set when RET is controlled by
the RRU or RFU through its ANTENNAPORT.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
40
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Exampl
e Value
Antenna and
feeder
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Cabinet
No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Subrack
No.
SRN
62
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Port No.
PN
R0A
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
ALD
Power
Switch
PWRSWI
TCH
ON
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Current
Alarm
Threshold
THRESH
OLDTYP
E
UER_SEL
F_DEFINE
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Undercurr
ent Alarm
Occur
Threshold
UOTHD
40
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Undercurr
ent Alarm
Clear
Threshold
UCTHD
60
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Overcurre
nt Alarm
Occur
Threshold
OOTHD
850
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Overcurre
nt Alarm
Clear
Threshold
OCTHD
750
Config
uratio
n
Object
MO
C
Parameter Name
Parameter ID
Example
Value
Ant
enn
a
Adding
RET
RET
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding
RET
CTRLCN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
41
Do
ma
in
Config
uratio
n
Object
and
feed
er
RET
MO
C
Parameter Name
Parameter ID
Example
Value
No.
Adding
RET
RET
CTRLSRN
62
Adding
RET
RET
CTRLSN
Adding
RET
RET
Antenna Type
RETTYPE
Single antenna
Adding
RET
RET
SUBUNITNUM
Adding
RET
RET
Polar Type
POLARTYPE
Equipment
plan
Adding
RET
RET
Antenna Scenario
SCENARIO
REGULAR
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Paramet
er Name
Paramet
er ID
Example
Value
Antenna and
feeder
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Device No.
DEVICEN
O
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Subunit No.
SUBUNITN
O
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Cabinet
No.
CONNCN1
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Subrack
No.
CONNSRN
1
62
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Slot No.
CONNSN1
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Port No.
CONNPN1
R0A
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
2 Cabinet
No.
CONNCN2
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
2 Subrack
CONNSRN
62
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
42
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Paramet
er Name
Paramet
er ID
No.
Tilt
TILT
Example
Value
20
Config
uratio
n
Object
MO
C
Parameter Name
Parameter ID
Example
Value
Ant
enn
a
and
feed
er
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLCN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLSRN
62
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLSN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
SUBUNITNUM
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Subunit No.
SUBUNITNO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Connect Port
Cabinet No.
CONNCN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Connect Port
Subrack No.
CONNSRN
62
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CONNSN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CONNPN
R0A
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
43
Do
mai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Working Mode
MODE
NORMA
L
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Gain
GAIN
48
If both RX channels of the RXU are configured with the TMA, attenuation must be
configured for the RXBRANCH of both RX channels. The following table describes the
parameters that must be set to configure RX channel attenuation.
Table 3.9 Key parameters related to RX channel attenuation
Do
mai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
RX Channel No.
RXNO
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
Logical Switch of
RX Channel
RXSW
ON
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
Attenuation
ATTEN
10
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
RX Channel No.
RXNO
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
Logical Switch of
RX Channel
RXSW
ON
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
Attenuation
ATTEN
10
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Service impact
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
44
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
45
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
46
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
47
Note that parts highlighted with blue are new components in the preceding figures.
In this scenario of mode transition, the RF module working on the new frequency band uses
an independent antenna but shares the original feeder due to installation constraints. In such a
case, you can use an independent antenna or reuse the original multiband multi-port antenna.
In addition, customers may replace the original antenna with a multiband multi-port antenna
due to constraints on site conditions.
A combiner must be added because multiple modes (frequency bands) share the feeder. The
combiner brings about insertion loss, which slightly affects the performance of the original
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
48
mode (frequency band). The insertion loss of an inter-band combiner is 0.X dB. For details,
see the relevant combiner datasheet.
This scenario has the following characteristics:
No new feeder
If an RET antenna is used, independent RET and electrical tilt configuration are
supported.
If an independent antenna is used, you can independently set the mechanical tilt.
2. Precautions
In scenarios of adding an RET or TMA, check the model, and hardware and software versions
of RET or TMA for compatibility. For details, contact GTAC or TMO teams. A list of RET or
TMA models that have passed the IOT compatibility test is available. If the RET or TMA to
be added is not included in the list, relevant tests by R&D or field engineers are
recommended.
Pay attention to frequency bands supported by the TMA, especially the reused TMA.
When a combiner is used, pay attention to the design of the RET and TMA, and combiner's
capability of supporting DC power and OOK signals.
Determine connections between components in the antenna and feeder subsystem.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
Antenna
Jumper
SBT
Required on the
antenna side when
the following
conditions are met:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
RET is configured
for the new
mode.
No TMA is
configured.
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
connected to
each other.
TMA
Configured as
required by the
network plan.
RCU
Required for
connecting to the
SBT or TMA when
RET is required. The
lengths of the AISG
cable vary with
scenarios.
Combiner
Version requirement
None
License requirement
The GSM and UMTS systems have no requirements for deploying this feature.
The feature license must be purchased when RET is used for LTE. The following table
provides the related license control items.
Table 3.2 License control items for optional features of RET management
Feature Name
License Control
Item
License
Abbreviation
(LTE-FDD) LOFD-001024
Remote Electrical Tilt Control
LLT1RET01
(LTE-TDD) TDLOFD-001024
Remote Electrical Tilt Control
LLT1RET01
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
50
- Based on connections of the RFU/RRU, antenna, and feeder, configure RF transmit and
receive mode for the GBTS, and TxBranch/RxBranch/RFCONNGRP information about
the RF module for the eGBTS, NodeB, eNodeB, and co-MPT base station.
- If RET is required, configure the ALD power supply switch for the RRU or RFU and
related alarm threshold parameters. In addition, configure RET for the RET antenna,
download the RET configuration file, calibrate the RET antenna, and set tilt angels.
- If a TMA is required, configure the TMA and TMA attenuation corresponding to the
RRU or RFU's channel.
For details, see section "Data Preparation" in "Engineering Guidelines (ALD Manual
Deployment on Multimode Base Station)" of ALD Management Feature Parameter
Description.
Examples:
The following table describes the key parameters that must be set when RET is
controlled by the RRU or RFU through its RETPORT.
Table 3.3 Key parameters related to the RETPORT
Domai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Param
eter ID
Example
Value
Antenna
and
feeder
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Cabinet No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Subrack No.
SRN
62
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Port No.
PN
RET_PORT
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
ALD Power
Switch
PWRSWI
TCH
ON
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Current Alarm
Threshold
THRESH
OLDTYP
E
UER_SELF_DEF
INE
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Undercurrent
Alarm Occur
Threshold
UOTHD
40
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Undercurrent
Alarm Clear
Threshold
UCTHD
60
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Overcurrent
Alarm Occur
Threshold
OOTHD
850
Adding an
RXU
RETPORT
Overcurrent
Alarm Clear
Threshold
OCTHD
750
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
51
The following table describes the key parameters that must be set when RET is
controlled by the RRU or RFU through its ANTENNAPORT.
Table 3.4 Key parameters related to the ANTENNAPORT
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parame
ter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Exampl
e Value
Antenna and
feeder
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Cabinet
No.
CN
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Subrack
No.
SRN
62
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Slot No.
SN
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Port No.
PN
R0A
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
ALD
Power
Switch
PWRSWI
TCH
ON
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Current
Alarm
Threshold
THRESH
OLDTYP
E
UER_SEL
F_DEFINE
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Undercurr
ent Alarm
Occur
Threshold
UOTHD
40
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Undercurr
ent Alarm
Clear
Threshold
UCTHD
60
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Overcurre
nt Alarm
Occur
Threshold
OOTHD
850
Adding an
RXU
ANTENNAPO
RT
Overcurre
nt Alarm
Clear
Threshold
OCTHD
750
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
52
Config
uratio
n
Object
MO
C
Parameter Name
Parameter ID
Example
Value
Ant
enn
a
and
feed
er
Adding
RET
RET
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding
RET
RET
CTRLCN
Adding
RET
RET
CTRLSRN
62
Adding
RET
RET
CTRLSN
Adding
RET
RET
Antenna Type
RETTYPE
Single antenna
Adding
RET
RET
SUBUNITNUM
Adding
RET
RET
Polar Type
POLARTYPE
Equipment
plan
Adding
RET
RET
Antenna Scenario
SCENARIO
REGULAR
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Paramet
er Name
Paramet
er ID
Example
Value
Antenna and
feeder
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Device No.
DEVICEN
O
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Subunit No.
SUBUNITN
O
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Cabinet
No.
CONNCN1
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Subrack
No.
CONNSRN
1
62
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Slot No.
CONNSN1
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
1 Port No.
CONNPN1
R0A
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
53
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Paramet
er Name
Paramet
er ID
Example
Value
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
2 Cabinet
No.
CONNCN2
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Connect Port
2 Subrack
No.
CONNSRN
2
62
Adding RET
RETSUBU
NIT
Tilt
TILT
20
Config
uratio
n
Object
MO
C
Parameter Name
Parameter ID
Example
Value
Ant
enn
a
and
feed
er
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLCN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLSRN
62
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CTRLSN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
SUBUNITNUM
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Device No.
DEVICENO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Subunit No.
SUBUNITNO
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Connect Port
Cabinet No.
CONNCN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
54
Do
mai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Connect Port
Subrack No.
CONNSRN
62
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CONNSN
Adding a
TMA
TMA
CONNPN
R0A
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Working Mode
MODE
NORMA
L
Adding a
TMA
TMA
Gain
GAIN
48
If both RX channels of the RXU are configured with the TMA, attenuation must be
configured for the RXBRANCH of both RX channels. The following table describes the
parameters that must be set to configure RX channel attenuation.
Table 3.9 Key parameters related to RX channel attenuation
Do
mai
n
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parameter
ID
Exampl
e Value
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
RX Channel No.
RXNO
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
Logical Switch of
RX Channel
RXSW
ON
Adding
RXU RX
channel 0
RXBRANCH
Attenuation
ATTEN
10
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
RX Channel No.
RXNO
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
Logical Switch of
RX Channel
RXSW
ON
Adding
RXU RX
channel 1
RXBRANCH
Attenuation
ATTEN
10
Ante
nna
and
feed
er
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Service impact
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
55
Installing a combiner
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
56
Note that parts highlighted with blue are new components in the preceding figures.
In this scenario of mode transition, a new frequency band of new mode shares the broadband
antenna with one or more frequency bands of the original mode. In such a case, an external
combiner combines signals transmitted on multiple frequency bands.
This scenario has the following characteristics:
No new feeder
All modes share the same antenna or antenna port and independent RET is not supported.
2. Precautions
1) The combiner model is determined by frequency bands where signals are to be combined.
2) If the RF module is a broadband module providing the same output port for multiple bands
(for example, RRU3961), no external combiner is required.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
57
3. Engineering guidelines
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
Antenna
Jumper
Combiner
Version requirement
None
License requirement
None. The antenna and feeder license of the original mode is used.
Service impact
Installing a combiner
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
58
In this scenario of mode transition, an original antenna or feeder is available for refarming and
no modification is required.
2. Precautions
None
3. Engineering guidelines
Version requirement
None
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
59
License requirement
None. The antenna and feeder license of the original mode is used.
None. The antenna and feeder configuration of the original mode is used.
Service impact
None
The following table provides the comparison between separate-MPT and co-MPT
configurations.
Table 1.1 Comparison between separate-MPT and co-MPT configurations
Comparison Item
Co-MPT
Separate-MPT
Hardware
Inter-RAT decoupling
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
60
Comparison Item
Co-MPT
Separate-MPT
coupled.
Shared resources
Sharing is implemented
through the following
features: co-transmission,
common reference clock,
and CPRI MUX. Baseband
resources cannot be shared
between modes.
An OM channel must be
enabled for the new mode
and new baseband resources
must be deployed.
UBBP co-baseband
Co-baseband is supported
by UBBP or UMDU boards.
Co-baseband is not
supported by UBBP boards.
Version upgrade
All-at-once upgrade
O&M experience
Note that the BBU3910A supports only co-MPT mode transition but not separate-MPT mode
transition.
Whether Co-MPT or separate-MPT is used depends on whether the new main control board
works in a new mode independently. If multiple modes are added, you need to perform the
operations in the preceding process for each mode. For example, in mode transition from
GSM to G&[U*L], if UMTS is the first mode to be added, UMTS will be deployed on a new
main control board. In this case, separate-MPT is used for mode transition to UMTS but the
NodeB is a co-MPT base station. In addition, if LTE is the second mode to be added, LTE is
deployed on the UMTS main control board. In this case, co-MPT is used for mode transition.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
61
SeparateMPT or CoMPT
Scenario
Co-MPT or
separateMPT
planning
Separate-MPT
Co-MPT mode
expansion
The BBU3900 or BBU3910 supports a maximum of two main control boards. When separateMPT is used, the BBU3900 and BBU3910 support mode transition from a single mode to
dual-mode, for example, transition from GSM to GU or GL, or from UMTS to UL.
This scenario is applicable to the mode transition from single-mode to dual-mode. The
following two applications are supported:
SDR RF module working in both the original mode and the new mode (separate-MPT
and common mode)
The BBU3910A does not support mode transition when separate-MPT is used and therefore
does not support this scenario.
For details about how to select main control boards, see GUL Base Station Overview and
Selection Guide.
2. Precautions
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
62
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
UMPT(L)/LMPT
An LTE main
control board is
added.
NOTE
Use a newly delivered
board because such
boards work in the
maintenance mode by
default. If you do not
use a newly delivered
board, this board may
not work in the
maintenance mode,
and a false alarm may
be generated during
mode transition and
services of the newly
deployed mode may
be interrupted.
UMPT(U)/WMPT
A UMTS main
control board is
added.
NOTE
Use a newly delivered
board because such
boards work in the
maintenance mode by
default. If you do not
use a newly delivered
board, this board may
not work in the
maintenance mode,
and a false alarm may
be generated during
mode transition and
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
63
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
services of the newly
deployed mode may
be interrupted.
GTMU
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the baseband processing boards and versions, see 3900
Series Base Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
No specific license control item is available for the main control board working in a separateMPT multimode base station.
Therefore, a license related to the new mode can be applied for in the same way as that for the
license of each involved mode.
UMPT multimode licenses must be applied for only when the UMPT or UMDU work in co-MPT and
multimode concurrency is applied. If the UMPT/UMDU works only in one mode, there is no need to
apply for such licenses. The UMPT multimode licenses include UMPT Multi Mode license(GSM),
UMPT Multi Mode license(UMTS), UMPT Multi Mode license(LTE FDD), and UMPT Multi Mode
license(LTE TDD).
There is no special data configuration for the newly added main control board working in a
separate-MPT multimode base station. Note that if a multimode feature is required, refer to
the related feature descriptions, such as descriptions about the RF module and common
reference.
For configuration of common resources in a multimode base station, pay attention to the
following items:
- Configure equipment data (such as the power supply, fan, and environment monitoring
board) only for one mode. It is recommended that the equipment data be configured on the
original mode so that no data migration is involved.
In separate-MPT, you are not advised to configure data of mechanical and electrical parts for multiple
modes together because data consistency issues may occur.
- The number of all common resources at the entire site shall be unique. For example, two
non-SDR RF modules working in two different modes cannot have the same cabinet No.,
subrack No., or slot No. The same cabinet No., subrack No., or slot No. must be configured
for SDR RF modules working in two different modes.
For details about data configurations, see the following:
Configuration mode: MML/GUI/SUMMARY
Guidelines: Creating Base Stations > Creating Separate-MPT Multimode Base Stations in
3900 Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
64
Resources required for each mode are managed by a "brain." Environment alarms and fans are
managed by the mode specified manually. That is, you can configure parameters related to the
environment, alarm, and fan only for one mode.
Service impact
Whether SDR Is
Used or Not
Scenario
Impact on Services
of the Original Mode
No SDR
None
Upgrading software of a
new main control board
None
Activating data
configuration of a new main
control board
None
Replacing a BBU/UPEU
Upgrading software of a
new main control board
Activating data
configuration of a new main
control board
Replacing a BBU/UPEU
SDR
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
65
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Board
BBU
UMPT
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Remarks
66
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the main control boards and versions, see 3900 Series
Base Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
No specific license control item is available for the main control board working in a separateMPT multimode base station.
Therefore, a license related to the new mode can be applied for in the same way as that for the
license of each involved mode.
UMPT multimode licenses must be applied for only when the UMPT or UMDU work in co-MPT and
multimode concurrency is applied. If the UMPT/UMDU works only in one mode, there is no need to
apply for such licenses. The UMPT multimode licenses include UMPT Multi Mode license(GSM),
UMPT Multi Mode license(UMTS), UMPT Multi Mode license(LTE FDD), and UMPT Multi Mode
license(LTE TDD).
There is no special data configuration for the newly added main control board working in a
separate-MPT multimode base station. Note that if a multimode feature is required, refer to
the related feature descriptions, such as descriptions about the RF module and common
reference.
For configuration of common resources in a multimode base station, pay attention to the
following items:
- Configure equipment data (such as the power supply, fan, and environment monitoring
board) only for one mode. It is recommended that the equipment data be configured on the
original mode so that no data migration is involved. When two BBUs are used, all the
equipment is connected to the primary BBU subrack and such equipment data is configured in
one mode of the primary BBU subrack.
- The number of all common resources at the entire site shall be unique. For example, two
non-SDR RF modules working in two different modes cannot have the same cabinet No.,
subrack No., or slot No. The same cabinet No., subrack No., or slot No. must be configured
for SDR RF modules working in two different modes.
- BBU interconnection data must be configured when two BBUs are used. For details, see
section BBU Interconnection Feature Parameter Description in this document.
You can use the GUI, summary data file, or MML commands to configure the data.
For details, see 3900 Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide. The related descriptions
can be obtained by choosing Creating Base Stations > Creating Separate-MPT Multimode
Base Stations.
Resources required for each mode are managed by a "brain." Environment alarms and fans are
managed by the mode specified manually. That is, you can configure parameters related to the
environment, alarm, and fan only for one mode.
Service impact
Whether SDR Is
Used or Not
Scenario
Impact on Services
of the Original Mode
No SDR
None
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
67
Whether SDR Is
Used or Not
Scenario
Impact on Services
of the Original Mode
control board
Inter-BBU SDR
None
Upgrading software of a
new main control board
None
Activating data
configuration of a new main
control board
None
None
None
Upgrading software of a
new main control board
Activating data
configuration of a new main
control board
68
Material requirement
N/A
Version requirement
License requirement
License
BBOM
License
Abbreviatio
n
Sales
Unit
Mode
82204202
LGB3UMML01
Per BTS
GSM
82203981
LQW9GUDM0
1
Per
NodeB
UMTS
82204259
LLT1UMML01
Per
eNodeB
LTE
82204285
LLT1TUMML0
1
Per
eNodeB
LTE
All the preceding multimode licenses are required only when co-MPT multimode concurrency is used
for the UMPT/UMDU. No license is required for the first mode of a co-MPT base station. However,
such licenses are required for other modes of the base station.
Original mode:
No data modification is involved for the original mode in terms of MPT configuration.
New mode:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
69
The configuration data of the new mode must be complete, including RAT data, RF data,
transmission data, and sector data.
For mode transition from FDD only or TDD only to FDD and TDD concurrency, MOs such
as Application, Function, and X2/S1 do not need to be configured during configuration
(unless required by customers), and the operations are similar to adding an inter-frequency
cell in the same mode. For example, if the original base station has only TDD cells working
on the 2.3 GHz frequency band, add TDD cells working on the 2.6 GHz frequency band. For
details, see the related description in 3900 Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide >
Cell Data Reconfigurations.
The following table provides the related MO and parameter.
MO
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
NODE
Working
Mode
WM
Working
Mode
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If the GTMU is to be abandoned, CPRI ports on the UBBP or a newly added UBRI can
be used for the GSM mode. The main control and transmission function can be
implemented on the UMPT board (the UMPT does not support TDM transmission).
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
70
In GTMU evolution scenarios, CPRI ports remain on the GTMU. If the transmission
mode is IP over E1, the transmission ports remain on the GTMU. If the transmission
mode is IP over GE/FE, the transmission ports must be provided by the UMPT.
If the GBTS uses TDM transmission before the reconstruction, first change TDM
transmission into IP transmission and then perform a GBTS-to-eGBTS reconstruction.
2) The mode to be added after the co-MPT reconstruction must be of the same version as the
existing mode.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Board
UMPT
UBRI
Version requirement
The following table provides UMPT multimode licenses that need to be purchased.
License
Control Item
Name
License
BBOM
License
Abbreviatio
n
Sales
Unit
Mode
82204202
LGB3UMML01
per BTS
GSM
82203981
LQW9GUDM0
1
per
NodeB
UMTS
82204259
LLT1UMML01
per
eNodeB
LTE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
71
License
Control Item
Name
License
BBOM
License
Abbreviatio
n
Sales
Unit
Mode
82204285
LLT1TUMML0
1
per
eNodeB
LTE
All the preceding multimode licenses are required only when co-MPT multimode concurrency is used
for the UMPT/UMDU. No license is required for the first mode of a co-MPT base station. However,
such licenses are required for other modes of the base station.
The Features Included by eGBTS License File But Not Supported by the eGBTS
Site
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GBTS
Suppo
rted
eGBTS
Suppor
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly
built eGBTS
High Power
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
TRU which
works as
Multitransceivers
Resource of
the 3rd
generation
BTS (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
BBU Carrier
Capacity
License (per
TRX)
per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
GBFD115901
PBT(Power
Boost
Technology)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
72
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GBTS
Suppo
rted
eGBTS
Suppor
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly
built eGBTS
(per TRX)
GBFD115902
Transmit
Diversity (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
BTS3900B
Transceiver
Resource (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
2.
Multi-Carrier
60 W High
Power License
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Multi-Carrier
80 W High
Power License
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
TRU which
works as
Multitransceivers
Resource of
3900 (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Non-SubSite scene:
License = the number of
logical TRXs of eGBTS
the number of include GSM
TRX's Boards.
SubSite scene(Supported
begin eGBTS R16.0):
(1) International and China
Unicom: License = the
number of logical TRXs of
eGBTS * the number of
location groups the
number of RXUs from all
location groups.
(2) China Mobile:
License = the number of
logical TRXs of eGBTS
the number of RXUs from
the most RXUs location
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
73
group.
Related BSC MML:
LST GTRX;
LST BTSLOCGRPE;
Related eGBTS MML:
LST
GTRXGROUPSECTOREQ
M LST SECTOREQM
MRFD211801
Multi-mode
Dynamic
Power
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
Power Sharing Type set to
GUPWRSHR (GU Power
Sharing).
Related eGBTS MML:
LST GBTSPWRSHRGRP;
MRFD211703
2.0 MHz
Central
Frequency
point
separation
between GSM
and UMTS
mode(GSM)
(per Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
MRFD211804
GSM Power
Control on
Interference
Frequency for
GU Small
Frequency
gap(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Yes
Yes
MRFD211505
Bandwidth
sharing of
MBTS Multimode CoTransmission(
GBTS) (per
Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
MRFD211602
Multi-mode
BS Common
IPSec(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Yes
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
74
MRFD211803
GSM and
UMTS
Dynamic
Spectrum
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Dynamic MA
for GU
Dynamic
Spectrum
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Yes
Yes
License = 1 if Spectrum
Sharing Allowed of eGBTS
set to YES.
Related BSC MML:
LST GDSSPARA
Yes
Yes
License = 1 if in a eGBTS,
at least one channel's FH
Index Used After Frequency
Spectrum Sharing set to
value in range [0,63].
Related BSC MML:
LST GTRXCHANHOP;
MRFD211806
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
Power Sharing Type set to
GLPWRSHR (GL Power
Sharing).
Related eGBTS MML:
LST GBTSPWRSHRGRP;
MRFD211901
Multi-RAT
Carrier Joint
Shutdown(GB
TS) (per Site)
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
GBFD116602
IPSec Bypass
(per Site)
Per
BTS
No
Yes
UMPT MultiMode
License(GSM)
(per UMPT)
Per
UMPT
No
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
75
Antenna
Intermodulatio
n Performance
Detection (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Extended
Spectrum Scan
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
3.
Feature
ID
License
Descripti
on
Sal
e
Uni
t
GBTS
Supp
orted
eGBTS
Suppor
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly
built eGBTS
GBFD151202
BTS IP
Active
Performance
Measuremen
t (per Site)
Per
BTS
No
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
TWAMPCLIENT or
TWAMPRESPONDER
function is enabled.
Related BTS MML:
LST TWAMPCLIENT
LST TWAMPRESPONDER
4.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
76
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
SubSite
Solution
License (per
Module)
Per
Module
Yes
Yes
RFU co-cell
Solution
License (per
Module)
Per
Module
Yes
Yes
GBFD115903
4-Way
Receiver
Diversity (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
GBFD160209
GBFD160210
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Per
Module
IPSec
redundancy
among multiSeGWs (per
BTS)
Per
BTS
BTS
supporting
PKI
redundancy
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
77
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
(per BTS)
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
LST CA
LST CRLTSK
MRFD261103
AAS RAT
Specific
Tilting (GSM)
(Per RU)
Per RU
No
Yes
Not
Commer
cial
AAS Virtual
Four Uplink
Channels for
GSM (per
RU)
Per RU
No
Yes
5.
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BTS
Sup
por
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD170205
GTMUb
SingleOM
(Per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
6.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
78
Featur
e ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Sup
por
ted
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD171205
BTS
Supporting
Multi-Carrier
PKI (per
BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
GBFD171206
BTS
Supporting
IPSec
Redirection
(per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(GSM) (Per
Band per
RRU)
per
Band
per
RRU
Yes
Yes
7.
Featur
e ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GBT
S
Sup
por
ted
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD181202
BTS
Supporting
Digital
Certificate
Whitelist
Management
(Per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
79
Perform co-MPT reconstruction for the original mode and expand the capacity for the new
mode after the co-MPT reconstruction is finished.
The configuration data must be modified when the co-MPT reconstruction is performed.
New mode:
The configuration data of the new mode must be complete, including RAT data, RF data,
transmission data, and sector data.
For mode transition from FDD only or TDD only to FDD and TDD concurrency, MOs such
as Application, Function, and X2/S1 do not need to be configured during configuration
(unless required by customers), and the operations are similar to adding an inter-frequency
cell in the same mode. For example, if the original base station has only TDD cells working
on the 2.3 GHz frequency band, add TDD cells working on the 2.6 GHz frequency band. For
details, see the related description in 3900 Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide >
Cell Data Reconfigurations.
The following table provides the related MO and parameter.
MO
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
NODE
Working
Mode
WM
Working
Mode
For the BSC redundancy scenario, two data planning tables need to be filled out. One is
for the primary BSC and the other for the secondary BSC.
The BBU3910A only supports the co-MPT reconstruction in UMTS only or LTE only
scenario. Therefore, you only need to fill in the ConvertFlag, NodeBName, or
eNodeBName field in the SitePlanning page.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
b.
BtsSctpPortBase and BtsTrxPerSctp use the planned values. In the BSC node
redundancy scenario, BtsSctpPortBase and BtsTrxPerSctp must be set to the same
value in the data planning tables of the primary BSC and secondary BSC.
c.
BtsOMCHPeerIP: Enter the IP address of the U2000. This field is mandatory for
GO reconstruction and batch reconstruction scenarios.
d.
80
e.
f.
g.
h.
The UMTS only or LTE only reconstruction scenario is not involved in this page.
If multiple base stations are reconstructed, the planning data of each base station must be
filled. Each row corresponds to a base station. Do not leave any blank row between two filled
rows. Otherwise, the data cannot be converted.
To reduce the GSM service interruption duration, load the GTMUb conversion software
before the GU/GL/GU+L/GL+U co-MPT reconstruction. In this scenario, you are advised to
perform reconstruction for ten sites at a time. The BSC script is executed in serial. If too many
sites are reconstructed in a batch, execution of the script may not be finished within the
required duration (8 to 12 minutes) of service interruption.
If GSM base stations are cascaded using IPoE1, it is recommended that the cascaded BTSs be
reconstructed in a batch. In the GO co-MPT reconstruction scenario, you are advised to
reconstruct all the cascaded base stations at the same time, which will reduce service
interruption duration. For the co-MPT reconstruction for GU, GL, and GUL base stations,
when activating the GTMU conversion software, you are advised to activate the base stations
from the lowest cascading level to the first level. When starting a PnP task, execute the
Download BSC Configuration Data command only on the base stations of the first
cascading level.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
ScenarioId: It is a reserved parameter and used for future expansion. It does not need to
be specified.
81
ConvertFlag: "Yes" indicates that the configuration data for the site corresponding to
this row needs to be converted.
SRANName: name of the co-MPT base station after reconstruction. It must be different
from the base station name before reconstruction. If it is left blank, a name of the base
station with the reference mode will be created automatically. The name that is
automatically created uses the NE name of the reference mode specified by the
SRANBaselineRAT field. If SRANBaselineRAT is left unspecified, the NE name of a
more recent mode is used. SRANBaselineRAT must be set to SingleRAN for a hybridMPT base station. If SRANName is unspecified for the hybrid-MPT base station, the
value of SRANNameBfConvert is used.
NextHop: mandatory when the GBTS uses IPoFE. Enter the next-hop IP address of the
Ethernet interface of the GBTS. (When GSM uses Ethernet transmission, this parameter
must be specified to ensure that a correct route is generated on the GSM side. When the
Abis interface uses layer-2 networking mode, the IP address of the BTS gateway is the
interface IP address of board where the BSC IP address is located. When non-cotransmission or co-transmission based on panel interconnection is used, enter the nexthop IP address on the GSM side and the IP address must be on the same network
segment as the IP address of the Ethernet port type of the BTSDEVIP, and the IP address
cannot be the same as BTSDEVIP. When co-transmission through backplane
interconnection is used, enter the next-hop IP address of the board that provides
transmission, and it must be in the same network segment as the DEVIP of the board but
cannot be the same as the DEVIP.)
IPHCSUBOPT: Fill in this field according to the actual situation (When the base station
directly connects to the base station controller using IP over E1 or connects to the upperlevel base station, set it to DISABLE. When the base station connects to a router using IP
over E1, set it to ENABLE).
IPoE1OMIP: Enter the original BTSIP or an IP address in the same network segment as
the IP address of the original PPP/MP port. When GSM mode uses transmission of
IP_OVER_FE/GE_AND_E1(E1 backup), this parameter is mandatory.
ClkSrc: used for base station clock data conversion. The default value NULL indicates
that the clock synchronization is performed in the default order of priority as follows:
GPS > IPCLK > SYNCETH > LINECLK > TOD > BITS > SYNCETH+IPCLK. For a
hybrid clock reference source, you are advised to run the SET CLKMODE command to
manually configure it.
GTMU Abandoned, UMPTSlot, and GTMU CPRI Move TemplateName: For the
GTMU abandoning scenario, the parameters must be filled. They specify the slot that
holds the main control board where the GSM mode is deployed and the CPRI adjustment
mode of the abandoned GTMU. The CPRI adjustment method of the abandoned GTMU
depends on the information that is filled in the MultiCpriChainMoveTemplate sheet.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
82
If a UMPT working in non-baseline RAT will not be used any longer, set it to No. In this
case, the peer main control processing unit will be degraded to a slave or standby board
using an MML command manually rather than during the reconstruction or the board can
be relocated to be used in other places.
If the peer main control processing unit is a GTMU/WMPT/LMPT, this field does not
affect the reconstruction process.
MPTType
Main control board type after the co-MPT reconstruction, mandatory The default value is
UMPT if the parameter is not filled out.
In the GTMU SingleOM scenario, the field must be filled with GTMUb or GTMUc. The
fields used in the GTMU abandoning scenario must not be selected. The field and the
fields involved in the GTMU abandoning scenario are mutually exclusive.
UmptBrdspec
Hardware type of the UMPT after the reconstruction, optional The default value is
UMPTa or UMPTb if the parameter is not filled out.
If the main control board for a co-MPT base station is the UMPTe in reconstruction
scenarios, fill this field with UMPTe.
The UMPTa/b and UMPTe with the same specifications have the same model but different
capabilities. The configured specifications after reconstruction may exceed the board
capability. Therefore, the configuration cannot take effect even though succeeds. It is
recommended that the configured specifications be checked to determine whether they have
exceeded the actual board capability. If they have exceeded the actual board capability, the
extra specifications cannot take effect. For details, see the notes for the following MML
commands in the MML reference of 3900 Series Base Station MML reference:
ADD CPBEARER
ADD SCTPLNK
ADD ACL
ADD ACLRULE
ADD IPSECPOLICY
ADD IKEPEER
ADD SECURITYPEER
ADD SCTPPEER
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
83
UmptBrdspec indicates the type of a UMPT after reconstruction and its default
value is UMPTa or UMPTb. Fill this field according to the actual situation.
Otherwise, the configurations cannot take effect after reconstruction because the
UMPTa/b and UMPTe support different cell specifications.
If the base station before reconstruction uses E1/T1 transmission (including E1/T1
over IP or E1/T1 over ATM), the UMPTe cannot serve as the main control board for
the co-MPT base station after reconstruction because the UMPTe does not support
E1/T1 transmission.
If the UMPTe serves as the main control board for the co-MPT base station after
reconstruction, the main control boards (including WMPT and LMPT) before
reconstruction are abandoned and removed from the subrack, and the main control
board (UMPTa/b) before reconstruction is retained and serves as the signaling
extension board for the UMPTe.
The system converts the data configurations according to the following principles and
the actual transmission must also be deployed as follows:
LMPT electrical port 0 is converted to UMPTe electrical port 0.
LMPT electrical port 1 is converted to UMPTe electrical port 2.
LMPT optical port 0 is converted to UMPTe optical port 1.
LMPT optical port 1 is converted to UMPTe optical port 3.
OnlyConvertBaselineTranFlag
From SRAN10.1 onwards, the transport data of only the reference mode is incorporated
into the co-MPT base station during co-MPT data conversion. Fill this field with Yes.
Its default value is No, indicating that transport data of both reference and non-reference
modes is incorporated.
If OnlyConvertBaselineTranFlag on the SitePlanning page is set to Yes, the transport data of only the
reference mode is incorporated into the co-MPT base station and that of the non-reference mode must be
manually entered according to the actual situation. For the method of manual configuration, see 3900
Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide > Configuring Transport Data About the Co-MPT Base
Station in 3900 Series Base Station Product Documentation.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
84
The CPRI adjustment method of the abandoned GTMU depends on the information that is
filled in the MultiCpriChainMoveTemplate sheet.
In scenarios where the GTMU is to be abandoned and GSM baseband signals are processed
by RF modules, a UBRI or UBBPd can be added during the reconstruction to carry CPRI
signals of GSM. Alternatively, the UBBPd for UMTS or LTE can also be used to carry the
CPRI signals of GSM. In scenarios where the baseband processing board of UMTS or LTE is
WBBP or LBBP, respectively, the WBBP or LBBP cannot be replaced with the UBBPd during
the reconstruction. Therefore, a UBRI is added to carry the CPRI signals of GSM.
For example, Default_Template is used in GTMU abandoning scenarios where the UMTS
baseband processing board is WBBP and a UBRI is to be added for processing GSM signals.
Move all the CPRI ports on the GTMU to the UBRI in slot 1, as shown in the following
templates.
All CPRI ports on the GTMU to be abandoned must be filled in the following table for the
replacement. The GTMU CPRIPort field indicates a CPRI port on the GTMU. The GTMU
CPRIPort Need CpriMux field indicates whether CPRI-Sharing is used by GSM CPRI ports
after the relocation. The Dest UBRI/UBBP BrdType, Dest UBRI/UBBP Slot, and Dest
UBRI/UBBP CPRIPort fields indicate the positions where the GTMU CPRI ports are
located after being relocated.
In the GTMU abandoning scenario where the baseband processing board of UMTS or LTE is
the UBBPd, if there is no idle CPRI port on the UBBPd, you can set the GTMU CPRIPort
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
85
Need CpriMux field to convert the CPRI dual-star typology before the reconstruction to the
CPRI chain typology. As shown in the following table, move the CPRI cables on the GTMU
into the specified ports on the UBBPd in slot 2 and slot 3. CPRI port 0 on the GTMU does not
connect to any fiber optic cable. Instead, the fiber optic cable inserted in CPRI port 4 on the
UBBPd in slot 2 is converted to use CPRI multiplexing.
Ensure that the main control board deployed with the reference mode is retained after site
consolidation.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
86
During a co-MPT reconstruction from a UO, LO, UL, or some hybrid-MPT base stations,
convert the replaced WMPT or LMPT.
If the UMPTe serves as the main control board for the co-MPT base station after
reconstruction, the main control boards (including WMPT and LMPT) before reconstruction
are abandoned and removed from the subrack, and the main control board (UMPTa/b) before
reconstruction is retained and serves as the signaling extension board for the UMPTe.
(1) Adjusting data for WMPT evolution
After the co-MPT base station works properly, run the ADD BRD command to add a WMPT
board with Board Type set to WMPT and Slot No. set to 6. You cannot abandon the WMPT
without customer's permission. The WMPT must be in position but not be used.
(2) Adjusting data for LMPT evolution
After the co-MPT base station works properly, run the ADD BRD command to add an LMPT
board with Board Type set to LMPT and Slot No. set to 6.
3. Modifying GSM clock parameters
For the reconstruction of UMTS and LTE, if the original base station is a GSM and UMTS or
GSM and LTE multimode base station, check whether ClkType is set to PEER_CLK and
STANDARD is set to UMTS or LTE. If yes, set STANDARD to COMM.
(1) On the BSC LMT, run the LST BTSCLK command to check whether ClkType is set to
PEER_CLK and STANDARD is set to UMTS or LTE.
(2) If ClkType is set to PEER_CLK and STANDARD is set to UMTS or LTE, run the SET
BTSCLK command to modify STANDARD to COMM.
4. Modifying the OMCH IP of NodeBs on the MBSC
If a UMTS<E separate-MPT base station is to be reconstructed into a co-MPT base station
with mode expansion, and the LTE main control board is to be used as the main control board
of the co-MPT base station, adjust the OMCH IP of the corresponding MBSC of NodeB.
(1) Run the LST OMCH command to query the OMCH IP of the eNodeB.
(2) Run the MOD UNODEBIP command to modify the OMCH IP of the NodeB. Make the
OMCH IP of eNodeBs consistent with the NodeB. The following is an example: MOD
UNODEBIP: IDTYPE=BYID, NODEBID=1, NBTRANTP=IPTRANS_IP,
NBIPOAMIP="10.171.35.123", NBIPOAMMASK="255.255.255.0", IPSRN=0, IPSN=18,
IPLOGPORTFLAG=NO;
Service impact
Scenario
Co-MPT reconstruction
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
87
Interconnection
Through UCIU+UMPT
Interconnection Through
UMPT+UMPT
BBU
hardware
requirement
BBU3900+BBU3910
Requirement
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
BBU3900+BBU3900
BBU3910+BBU3910
88
Comparis
on Item
Interconnection
Through UCIU+UMPT
Interconnection Through
UMPT+UMPT
for distance
between
BBUs
interconnection can be 2
meters or 10 meters.
Hardware
requirement
for the main
control board
Cost
Feature
Limitations
Slot
N/A
Installability
N/A
Scenario
BBU
interconnection
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
89
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
License requirement
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
90
None
A UCIU occupies one slot in the primary BBU subrack. The BBU that is configured with the
UCIU is the primary BBU subrack (BBU 0). You can configure the UCIU in slot 4, 5, 0, or 1
(in the descending order of priority) in BBU 0.
The main control board in the leaf BBU (BBU 1) for interconnection must be the UMPT.
An inter-BBU signal cable is used to connect an M port on the UCIU in BBU 0 to a CI port
on the UMPT in BBU 1. You are advised to use the following M ports on the UCIU in
sequence: M0, M1, M2, M3, and M4.
Be aware of the distance limitations for BBU interconnection. The maximum length of an
inter-BBU signal cable for BBU interconnection through UCIU+UMPT can be 10 meters. If
an inter-BBU signal cable of over 10 meters is required, you need to customize it first.
The BBU3910 cannot be configured with a UCIU.
When two BBUs are interconnected, the monitoring device must be connected to BBU 0 and
related software can be configured in and monitored by the mode configured in the primary
BBU subrack.
In separate-MPT scenarios, GSM (GBTS/eGBTS) must be deployed only in BBU 0.
A UCIU must be configured in the primary BBU subrack (BBU 0). If two modes are
configured in the primary BBU subrack, the UCIU can be configured only with one mode and
the mode's priority is GSM, UMTS, and LTE in a descending order.
The cabinet and subrack numbers of the primary BBU subrack and secondary BBU subrack
must be unique and do not conflict with each other.
The CTRLLNK or BTSCTRLLNK MO must be configured for all involved modes.
Ports of each control link and BTS control link must be determined for both sides. Links to
BBU 0 and BBU 1 are of different levels. By default, BBU 1 is the lower-level node and BBU
0 is the upper-level node.
Numbers of control links and BTS control links must be unique and do not conflict with each
other.
Data of control links and BTS control links must be the same for all modes in the root and leaf
BBUs.
Table 1.1 MOC
Domai
n
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r ID
Para
mete
r
Name
Value
(Example
)
CME
Type
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
LN
Local
Link
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
CTRLLNK
CN
Local
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
91
Domai
n
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r ID
Para
mete
r
Name
Value
(Example
)
CME
Type
BBU
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SRN
Local
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SN
Local
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPCN
Upper
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSRN
Upper
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSN
Upper
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPPT
Upper
Port
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
LN
Local
Link
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
CN
Local
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SRN
Local
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SN
Local
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
All
CTRLLNK
UPCN
Upper
Equipment
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
92
Domai
n
Config
uratio
n
Object
intercon
nection
modes in
the root
BBU
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSRN
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
BBU
intercon
nection
All
modes in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
MOC
Para
mete
r ID
Para
mete
r
Name
Value
(Example
)
CME
Type
Upper
Subrack
No.
Equipment
UPSN
Upper
Slot
No.
Equipment
UPPT
Upper
Port
No.
Equipment
Cabinet
No.
Service impact
Scenario
No Inter-BBU SDR
Inter-BBU SDR
Related document
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
93
Version requirement
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
94
License requirement
None
The cabinet and subrack numbers of the primary BBU subrack and secondary BBU subrack
must be unique and do not conflict with each other.
The CTRLLNK or BTSCTRLLNK MO must be configured for all involved modes.
Ports of each control link and BTS control link must be determined for both sides. Links to
BBU 0 and BBU 1 are of different levels. By default, BBU 1 is the lower-level node and BBU
0 is the upper-level node.
Numbers of control links and BTS control links must be unique and do not conflict with each
other.
Data of control links and BTS control links must be the same for all modes in the root and leaf
BBUs.
Table 1.1 MOC
Domai
n
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r ID
Para
mete
r
Name
Value
(Example
)
CME
Type
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
LN
Local
Link
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
CN
Local
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SRN
Local
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
SN
Local
Slot
No.
Equipment
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
95
Domai
n
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r ID
Para
mete
r
Name
Value
(Example
)
CME
Type
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPCN
Upper
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSRN
Upper
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSN
Upper
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the root
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPPT
Upper
Port
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
LN
Local
Link
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
CN
Local
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
SRN
Local
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
SN
Local
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPCN
Upper
Cabinet
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSRN
Upper
Subrack
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPSN
Upper
Slot
No.
Equipment
BBU
intercon
nection
Mode in
the leaf
BBU
CTRLLNK
UPPT
Upper
Port
No.
Equipment
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Service impact
96
Scenario
No Inter-BBU SDR
Inter-BBU SDR
Related document
Currently, the following reference clocks can be used in a separate-MPT base station:
GPS clock, BITS clock, E1/T1 clock, IEEE1588v2 clock, and synchronous Ethernet clock.
For UMTS, when the WMPT, UTRP2, or UTRP9 uses the IEEE1588v2 reference clock, the
reference clock cannot be shared by any other mode.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Check whether the new mode can reuse the original clock.
97
If the new mode has time synchronization requirements and the original clock source is not of
the time synchronizing type, the original reference clock source cannot be shared.
Compa
rison
Item
Independent Clock
Common Clock
Clock
type
Working
mode
The working mode of the clock in a multimode base station cannot be set to
AUTO(Automatic). Only one type of reference clock can be configured for
each mode and the main control board of each mode. Reference clock backup
is not supported.
Inter-RAT
decouplin
g
Customer
Requirem
ents
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
98
Set FRAMESYNCSW to OFF if GBTS or eGBTS services do not need to support inter-site frame
number synchronization.
Before setting FRAMESYNCSW to ON, you need to perform frame number offset and training
sequence code planning to prevent interference between GSM neighboring cells.
The GTMUa board does not support time synchronization. When time synchronization is required, the
GTMUa board cannot be used and must be replaced.
Scenario
Clock
Version requirement
None
License requirement
None
Service impact
None
Related document
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for GSM
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for UMTS
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE FDD
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE TDD
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
99
Version requirement
The version requirement of clock sharing varies with the reference clock. For details, see
Common Clock Feature Parameter Description.
License requirement
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevia
tion
Sales
Unit
Mode
Multi-mode
BS Common
Reference
Clock(GBT
S)
None
None
None
per BTS
Multi-mode
BS Common
Reference
Clock(Node
B)
None
None
None
per NodeB
Multi-mode
BS Common
Reference
Clock(eNod
eB)
Multi-mode
BS Common
Reference
Clock(eNod
eB)(Per
eNodeB)
88030QUW
LLT1MCRC
01
Per eNodeB
Set the reference clock of the new mode to PEER so that the new mode and original mode
share the same reference clock. For details, see Common Clock Feature Parameter
Description.
Reference: Common Clock Feature Parameter Description
Configure MOs related to the peer clock.
GBTS:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
100
MO
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
BTSCLK
Clock
Type
ClkType
Clock Type
PEER_CLK
BTSCLK
Peer
Mode
STANDAR
D
Peer Mode
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
CLKMO
DE
Clock
Working
Mode
MODE
Clock
Working
Mode
CLKMO
DE
Selected
Clock
Source
CLKSRC
Selected
Clock
Source
PEERCL
K
Peer
Clock
No.
PN
Peer Clock
No
PEERCL
K
Peer
Standard
PS
Peer
Standard
Service impact
None
Related document
101
Version requirement
The reference clock of the new mode has requirements on the version. For details, see
the following documents:
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for GSM
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for UMTS
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE FDD
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE TDD
License requirement
Do
ma
in
Feature
Name
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
Licens
e
Contro
l Item
Name
(BBOM
)
License
Abbrev
iation
Sales
Unit
Mode
Clo
ck
Synchroniza
tion with
GPS
Synchronizati
on with GPS
None
None
Per eNodeB
Clo
ck
IEEE1588
V2 Clock
Synchroniza
tion
IEEE1588 V2
Clock
Synchronizati
on
LT1S00E
NSY00
88030FK
K
Per eNodeB
Do
mai
n
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r
Name
Paramet
er ID
Value
(Example
)
CME Type
Cloc
k
New-mode
base station
GPS
GPS
Clock
No.
GN
Equipment
New-mode
base station
GPS
Cable
Length
CABLE_L
EN
30
Equipment
New-mode
base station
GPS
GPS
workin
g mode
MODE
GPS
Equipment
New-mode
base station
GPS
Priority
PRI
Equipment
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
102
Do
mai
n
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Para
mete
r
Name
Paramet
er ID
Value
(Example
)
CME Type
New-mode
base station
IPCLK
LNK
Link
No.
LN
Equipment
New-mode
base station
IPCLK
LNK
Client
IPv4
CIP
82.0.1.107
Equipment
New-mode
base station
IPCLK
LNK
Server
IPv4
SIP
82.0.1.128
Equipment
New-mode
base station
IPCLK
LNK
Domain
DM
Equipment
New-mode
base station
IPCLK
LNK
Priority
PRI
Equipment
New-mode
base station
TASM
Clock
Workin
g Mode
MODE
MANUAL
Equipment
New-mode
base station
TASM
Selecte
d Clock
Source
CLKSRC
GPS
Equipment
New-mode
base station
TASM
Clock
Source
No.
SRCNO
Equipment
New-mode
base station
TASM
Clock
Synchr
onizatio
n Mode
CLKSYNC
MODE
TIME
Equipment
Service impact
None
Related document
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for GSM
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for UMTS
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE FDD
Synchronization Feature Parameter Description for LTE TDD
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
103
Compariso
n Item
Independent Baseband
Co-Baseband
Working
mode
Single mode
Multimode concurrency
Hardware
Inter-RAT
decoupling
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
104
SeparateMPT or CoMPT
Scenario
Baseband
planning
Separate-MPT
Co-MPT mode
expansion
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Board
LBBP/UBBP
Determined by the
number of cells and
number of initial
TX/RX channels
WBBP/UBBP
Determined by the
number of cells and
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Remarks
105
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
number of CEs
UBRIb
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the baseband processing boards and versions, see 3900
Series Base Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
No specific license control item is available for the baseband processing board working in a
separate-MPT multimode base station.
Therefore, a license related to the new mode can be applied for in the same way as that for the
license of each involved mode.
Mode licenses related to the UBBP must be purchased and delivered even when co-baseband
is not used.
Mode
License
Control Item
Name (SBOM)
License
Control Item
Name (BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
GSM
UBBP First-Mode
license (GSM)
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP First-Mode
license (UMTS)
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
UBBP First-Mode
license (LTE FDD)
NA
88032BXR
WDMS0UF
MLF00
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (LTE FDD)
NA
UBBP First-Mode
license (LTE TDD)
NA
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (LTE TDD)
NA
UMTS
LTE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
(SBOM)
88032BXS
(SBOM)
88032KLF
(SBOM)
88032GDN
(SBOM)
WDMS0U
MMLF00
LT1SUMM
LFL01
LT1SUMM
LFL00
106
Note: In independent baseband scenarios, you only need to purchase the first-mode license for
the UBBP based on its working mode in terms of the SBOM. SBOM and BBOM information
about the related licenses is the same.
Service impact
None
Material requirement
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Board
LBBP/UBBP
Determined by the
number of cells and
number of initial
TX/RX channels
WBBP/UBBP
Determined by the
number of cells and
number of CEs
UBRIb
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Remarks
107
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the baseband processing boards and versions, see 3900
Series Base Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
No specific license control item is available for the baseband processing board working in a
separate-MPT multimode base station.
Therefore, a license related to the new mode can be applied for in the same way as that for the
license of each involved mode.
Mode licenses related to the UBBP must be purchased and delivered even when co-baseband
is not used.
Mode
License Control
Item Name (SBOM)
License
Control Item
Name (BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
GSM
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
NA
88032BXR
WDMS0UF
MLF00
NA
NA
NA
UMTS
LTE
(SBOM)
88032BXS
(SBOM)
88032KLF
(SBOM)
88032GDN
(SBOM)
WDMS0U
MMLF00
LT1SUMM
LFL01
LT1SUMM
LFL00
Note: In independent baseband scenarios, you only need to purchase the first-mode license for
the UBBP based on its working mode in terms of the SBOM. SBOM and BBOM information
about the related licenses is the same.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
108
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
BBP
Base
Band
Work
Standard
BBWS
Base Band
Work
Standard
MDU
Base
Band
Work
Standard
BBWS
Base Band
Work
Standard
Service impact
None
Material requirement
If the new mode and original mode share the original baseband processing board, no new
material is required.
If you need to replace the original baseband processing board, or expand the baseband
processing board's capacity, purchase a new UBBP board.
Version requirement
For the mapping relationship between the baseband processing boards and versions, see
3900 Series Base Station Software and Hardware Compatibility Description.
License requirement
A license related to the new mode can be applied for in the same way as that for the
license of each involved mode.
The following table lists licenses that need to be purchased and delivered for the UBBP
board.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
109
Mode
License Control
Item Name (SBOM)
License
Control Item
Name (BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
GSM
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (GSM)
82204551
LGMIUBB
P
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
UBBP Multi-Mode
license (UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UBP
DM01
NA
88032BXR
WDMS0UF
MLF00
NA
NA
NA
UMTS
LTE
(SBOM)
88032BXS
(SBOM)
88032KLF
(SBOM)
88032GDN
(SBOM)
WDMS0U
MMLF00
LT1SUMM
LFL01
LT1SUMM
LFL00
MO
Param
eter
Name
Paramet
er ID
CME
Paramet
er Name
Setting Notes
BBP
Base
Band
Work
Standard
BBWS
Base Band
Work
Standard
MDU
Base
Band
Work
Standard
BBWS
Base Band
Work
Standard
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
110
Scenario
CPRIbased
topology
RF modules can use CPRI MUX or the dual-star topology in multimode concurrency
scenarios. The dual-star topology is recommended for separate-MPT scenarios while CPRI
MUX is recommended for co-MPT scenarios. The following table provides the comparison
between CPRI MUX and the dual-star topology.
Compa
rison
Item
Dual-Star Topology
CPRI MUX
Service
impact
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
111
Compa
rison
Item
Dual-Star Topology
CPRI MUX
Material
cost
Labor
Cost
Reliability
Applicatio
n
condition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
112
2. Precautions
1) Limitations on the BBU3900 slot assignment (not applicable to the BBU3910): For
NodeBs, only the baseband processing board in slots 2 and 3 of the BBU in a NodeB is
allowed to provide CPRI ports for connection to RRUs. For eNodeBs, at least one baseband
processing board must be installed in slot 2 or slot 3 and CPRI ports can be provided by the
baseband processing board in slots other than slots 2 and 3.
2) One RF module is connected to the BBU through one CPRI cable. Higher reliability
requires two CPRI cables for connecting the BBU in the ring topology.
3) The length of the added CPRI cable is determined according to site survey. Determine
whether the CPRI fiber optic cable or the optical module works in a single mode or multiple
modes.
4) If the optical fiber is to be reused, check whether the optical fiber type matches the optical
fiber connector. If they do not match, the optical fiber must be transferred. For details, see
Reuse Guide and Checklist for CPRI Optical Cables in Distributed Base Stations.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
CPRI-based
topology
CPRI
electrical
cable
CPRI fiber
optic cable
CPRI optical
module
None
License requirement
None
No special requirements are involved. The following table provides the related MOs.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
113
MO
Parameter
Meaning
Chain No.
Topo Type
Indicates the type of the topology. In the ring topology, service data is
transferred through fiber optic cables on the HDLC links. In load
sharing, two CPRI fiber optic cables can be used for transferring
service data at the same time, which improves the transmission
capability. The physical states of the ring topology and load sharing
applications are similar.
Backup Mode
Indicates the backup mode of the RRU chain or ring, including cold
backup and hot backup. Cold backup indicates that when the link on
one end of the chain or ring fails, the service is interrupted for a short
period of time, and then continues on the other end of the chain or
ring. In hot backup mode, if the link on one end of the chain or ring
fails, the service switches to the other end of the chain or ring
immediately. In hot backup mode, only one RRU can be configured on
each chain. When the Topo Type parameter is set to RING and the
Backup Mode parameter is set to HOT, the head and the tail of the
ring must be configured on different BBUs.
Indicates the cabinet number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the subrack number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the slot number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the cabinet number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the subrack number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the slot number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the number of the tail CPRI port. Value NULL is displayed
for the RRU chain which does not have a tail CPRI port.
BreakPoint
Position1
BreakPoint
Position2
Access Type
Indicates the access type of the RRU. The local port is used for the
connection of panels. The BBP is directly connected to the RRU/RFU.
The peer port is used for the convergence of backplane. The BBP is
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
114
MO
Parameter
Meaning
connected to the IDX2 port to converge on other baseband processing
boards so that the BBP can be connected to the RRU/RFU.
Indicates the slot number of the converged party in CPRI MUX. When
this parameter is set to 255, no slot number of the converged party is
specified. When the BBU where CPRI MUX is used is BBU3900, this
parameter does not need to be specified. When the BBU where CPRI
MUX is used is BBU3910, this parameter must be specified.
Cascading Level
RRU No.
Service impact
Technically, services of the original mode are not affected. However, the related operations
are performed around antennas, you are advised to disable the original RF module based on
the actual site conditions to ensure personal safety.
New RF modules work in multiple modes or the single mode of original RF modules is
expanded to multiple modes.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
115
Other limitations: For an RRU or RFU whose version is earlier than V3, the dual-star
topology is used and CPRI rates on the two sides must be consistent. The system
automatically negotiates for a CPRI rate that is supported by both sides. Therefore,
during CPRI rate planning, pay attention to the CPRI rate that can be supported by the
optical module or CPRI interface board on the other side. For an RRU or RFU whose
version is later than V3, CPRI rates on the two sides can be different.
2. Precautions
1) In dual-star topology for separate-MPT scenarios, one CRPI link is for one mode and
services of a mode are not affected by other modes. In load sharing for co-MPT scenarios, two
CRPI links are shared by multiple modes and modes are randomly assigned to the CPRI link
based on load balancing rules.
2) The length of the added CPRI cable is determined according to site survey. Determine
whether the CPRI fiber optic cable or the optical module works in a single mode or multiple
modes.
3) If the optical fiber is to be reused, check whether the optical fiber type matches the optical
fiber connector. If they do not match, the optical fiber must be transferred. For details, see
Reuse Guide and Checklist for CPRI Optical Cables in Distributed Base Stations.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
1) Expanding the mode of the original RF module to multiple modes
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
CPRI-based
topology
CPRI
electrical
cable
CPRI fiber
optic cable
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
116
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
CPRI optical
module
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
CPRI-based
topology
CPRI
electrical
cable
CPRI fiber
optic cable
CPRI optical
module
License requirement
None
MO
Parameter
Meaning
Chain No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
117
MO
Parameter
Meaning
a base station.
Topo Type
Indicates the type of the topology. In the ring topology, service data is
transferred through fiber optic cables on the HDLC links. In load
sharing, two CPRI fiber optic cables can be used for transferring
service data at the same time, which improves the transmission
capability. The physical states of the ring topology and load sharing
applications are similar.
Backup Mode
Indicates the backup mode of the RRU chain or ring, including cold
backup and hot backup. Cold backup indicates that when the link on
one end of the chain or ring fails, the service is interrupted for a short
period of time, and then continues on the other end of the chain or
ring. In hot backup mode, if the link on one end of the chain or ring
fails, the service switches to the other end of the chain or ring
immediately. In hot backup mode, only one RRU can be configured on
each chain. When the Topo Type parameter is set to RING and the
Backup Mode parameter is set to HOT, the head and the tail of the
ring must be configured on different BBUs.
Indicates the cabinet number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the subrack number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the slot number of the board where the head CPRI port is
located.
Indicates the cabinet number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the subrack number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the slot number of the board where the tail CPRI port is
located. Value NULL is displayed for the RRU chain which does not
have a tail CPRI port.
Indicates the number of the tail CPRI port. Value NULL is displayed
for the RRU chain which does not have a tail CPRI port.
BreakPoint
Position1
BreakPoint
Position2
Access Type
Indicates the access type of the RRU. The local port is used for the
connection of panels. The BBP is directly connected to the RRU/RFU.
The peer port is used for the convergence of backplane. The BBP is
connected to the IDX2 port to converge on other baseband processing
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
118
MO
Parameter
Meaning
boards so that the BBP can be connected to the RRU/RFU.
Indicates the slot number of the converged party in CPRI MUX. When
this parameter is set to 255, no slot number of the converged party is
specified. When the BBU where CPRI MUX is used is BBU3900, this
parameter does not need to be specified. When the BBU where CPRI
MUX is used is BBU3910, this parameter must be specified.
Cascading Level
RRU No.
Service impact
Technically, services of the original mode are not affected. However, the related
operations are performed around antennas, you are advised to disable the original RF
module based on the actual site conditions to ensure personal safety.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
119
Limitations:
Restriction on service specifications: The maximum service specifications of CPRI
MUX are less that those of the dual-star topology. In CPRI MUX, the bandwidth of the
baseband processing board that connects to CPRI fiber optic cables and the backplane
bandwidth of the converging and converged parties of CPRI MUX are limited.
Therefore, the specifications must be calculated based on factors such as the number of
ports connecting to CPRI fiber optic cables, port rate, number of cascaded RF modules,
main control board combination, and baseband processing board type. For details, see
CPRI MUX Feature Parameter Description.
Restriction on the slot and board type: CPRI MUX has requirements on board types that
can be supported by the converging party and converged party. In addition, if a
BBU3900 is used, the converging party must be configured in a certain slot. For details,
see CPRI MUX Feature Parameter Description.
2. Precautions
1) The length of the added CPRI cable is determined according to site survey. Determine
whether the CPRI fiber optic cable or the optical module works in a single mode or multiple
modes.
2) If the optical fiber is to be reused, check whether the optical fiber type matches the optical
fiber connector. If they do not match, the optical fiber must be transferred. For details, see
Reuse Guide and Checklist for CPRI Optical Cables in Distributed Base Stations.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
1) If the mode of the original RXU is to expanded to multiple modes, no additional RXU
is required.
2) A new RF module is added to serve multiple modes.
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
Auxiliary
materials
CPRI
electrical
cable
CPRI fiber
optic cable
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
120
Material
Type
Material
Name
CPRI optical
module
Quantity
Remarks
cable.
License requirement
None
Parameter
Name
Parameter ID
Setting Notes
Data Source
Access Type
AT
Engineering design
HCN
Engineering design
HSRN
HSN
HPN
LSN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
For BBU3910s
used in separateMPT GU or GL
CPRI MUX and
BBU3900s, the
slot number does
not need to be
configured for
the converged
party. In this
Engineering design
Engineering design
Engineering design
Equipment plan
121
Parameter
Name
Parameter ID
Setting Notes
Data Source
For BBU3910s
used in separateMPT scenarios
with UL CPRI
MUX, set this
parameter to the
slot number of
board used by
the converged
party.
Service impact
Scenario
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
122
Independent
Transmission
Co-transmission
Port requirement
for transmission
devices
IP addresses
requirement
(minimum)
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
123
Comparison
Item
Independent
Transmission
Co-transmission
For panel co-transmission, an IP
address must be configured for the
co-transmission port.
For backplane co-transmission, no
port IP address needs to be planned
for the mode that does not provide
a transmission port.
Transmission
bandwidth
sharing
No sharing
Sharing
Co-IPsec/PKI
No sharing
Sharing is supported.
Reliability
SeparateMPT or CoMPT
Scenario
Transmissio
n
Separate-MPT
Co-MPT mode
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
124
Categor
y
SeparateMPT or CoMPT
Scenario
expansion
MPT configuration
Material requirement
Material requirements are determined by the transmission type of the new mode. For
details, see description about deployment of a base station of the new mode.
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Transmissio
n
E1/T1
electrical
cable
FE/GE
electrical
cable
One
FE/GE fiber
One
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Remarks
125
Material
Type
Material
Name
Quantity
Remarks
optic cable
FE/GE
optical
module
One
License requirement
Purchase the related license if the transmission type used by the new mode has license
requirements.
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
Transmission
New-mode main
control board
E1T1
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
ETHPORT
New-mode main
control board
PPPLNK
New-mode main
control board
MPGRP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
MPLNK
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
DEVIP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
IPRT
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
OMCH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPLNK
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
IPPATH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
EPGROUP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEHO
ST
Transmis
sion
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Transmis
sion
Transmis
sion
126
Domain
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEPE
ER
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPHOST
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPPEER
Transmis
sion
Service impact
Services of the original mode are not affected. The new mode can provide services after
it is configured, transmission links are connected, and the base station is reset.
Transmission networking selection: No change is required because the transmission for the
original mode remains unchanged.
2. Precautions
Backplane co-transmission is recommended because this requires no additional IP address or
panel interconnection cable.
3. Engineering guidelines
Material requirement
No additional material is required.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
127
License requirement
Related co-transmission licenses must be purchased.
Doma
in
Module
Type
License
SBOM
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUG
Per BTS
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
NodeB
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
eNodeB
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
Transmission
New-mode main
control board
TUNNEL
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
DEVIP
New-mode main
control board
IPRT
New-mode main
control board
OMCH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPLNK
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
IPPATH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
EPGROUP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEHO
ST
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEPE
ER
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPHOST
Transmis
sion
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Transmis
sion
Transmis
sion
128
Domain
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
New-mode main
control board
SCTPPEER
Transmis
sion
Original mode
providing a
transmission port
TUNNEL
Transmis
sion
Original mode
providing a
transmission port
IPRT
Transmis
sion
Original mode
providing a
transmission port
DHCPRELAYS
WITCH
Transmis
sion
Original mode
providing a
transmission port
DHCPSVRIP
Transmis
sion
Original mode:
The following items must be configured in the original mode:
- Backplane tunnel: The source slot number is set to the slot number of the board in the
original mode and the destination slot number is set to the slot number of the board in the new
mode.
- DHCP relay switch DHCPRELAYSWITCH and DHCP server IP address DHCPSVRIP
- uplink and downlink IP routes to the new mode
For details, see Co-Transmission Feature Parameter Description.
New mode:
- Backplane tunnel: The source slot number is set to the slot number of the board in the new
mode and the destination slot number is set to the slot number of the board in the original
mode.
- Configure the O&M IP address, service link, signaling link, and route of the new mode. For
details, see section "Configuring Transport Data" in 3900 Series Base Station Initial
Configuration Guide.
Service impact
Services of the original mode are not affected. The new mode can provide services once
it is started after the configuration and power-on.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
129
In mode transition of a separate-mode base station, the new mode provides a transmission port
connecting to the transmission network and the original mode shares the transmission port, as
shown in the following figure.
Material requirement
No additional material is required for backplane co-transmission.
License requirement
Related co-transmission licenses must be purchased.
Doma
in
Module
Type
License
SBOM
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUG
Per BTS
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
NodeB
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
eNodeB
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
Transmission
New-mode main
control board
E1T1
Transmis
sion
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
130
Domain
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
New-mode main
control board
ETHPORT
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
PPPLNK
New-mode main
control board
MPGRP
"Configuring
Transport Data" in
3900 Series Base
Station Initial
Configuration
Guide.
New-mode main
control board
MPLNK
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
TUNNEL
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
DEVIP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
IPRT
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
OMCH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPLNK
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
IPPATH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
EPGROUP
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEHO
ST
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
USERPLANEPE
ER
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPHOST
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
SCTPPEER
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
DHCPRELAYS
WITCH
Transmis
sion
New-mode main
control board
DHCPSVRIP
Transmis
sion
Original-mode
main control board
TUNNEL
Transmis
sion
Original-mode
main control board
DEVIP
Transmis
sion
Transmis
sion
Transmis
sion
131
Domain
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Original-mode
main control board
IPRT
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
Transmis
sion
Original mode:
- Configure a backplane tunnel.
- Add a device IP address.
- Adjust the IP route.
For details, see Co-Transmission Feature Parameter Description.
New mode:
- Configure the DHCP relay switch DHCPRELAYSWITCH and DHCP server IP address
DHCPSVRIP for the original mode.
- Configure a backplane tunnel.
- Configure an IP route for the original mode.
- Configure the O&M IP address, service link, signaling link, and route of the new mode. For
details, see section "Configuring Transport Data" in 3900 Series Base Station Initial
Configuration Guide.
Service impact
Services of the original mode are interrupted during the period from transmission cable
adjustment to new site deployment and activation of the original mode's data.
132
Material requirement
No new material is required.
License requirement
Related co-transmission licenses must be purchased.
Doma
in
Module
Type
License
SBOM
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUG
Per BTS
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
NodeB
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
eNodeB
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
Transmission
Node
DEVIP
Transmis
sion
Node
SCTPLNK
Node
IPPATH
Node
EPGROUP
Transmis
sion
Node
USERPLANEHO
ST
Transmis
sion
Node
USERPLANEPE
ER
Transmis
sion
Node
SCTPHOST
Transmis
sion
Node
SCTPPEER
Transmis
sion
Node
CPBEARER
Transmis
sion
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Transmis
sion
Transmis
sion
133
Domain
Configuratio
n Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
CME
Type
New RAT
ABIS
Transmis
sion
New RAT
GBTSABISCP
Transmis
sion
New RAT
IUB
Transmis
sion
New RAT
IUBCP
Transmis
sion
New RAT
S1
Transmis
sion
New RAT
S1INTERFACE
Transmis
sion
New RAT
X2
Transmis
sion
New RAT
X2INTERFACE
Transmis
sion
Original mode:
Data of the original mode does not need any modification.
Node-related data needs to the changed as follows:
1) A port IP address DEVIP must be configured for the new mode. Note that this parameter is
required only when the port IP address is required for the new mode. If no new port IP address
is required, the new mode and original mode share the same port IP address.
2) The service link, signaling link, and route of the new mode must be configured.
New mode:
For new mode GU:
1) CPBEARER referenced by NODE must be configured on the signaling plane of the new
mode.
2) IPPATH or EPGROUP referenced by NODE must be configured on the user plane of the
new mode.
For new mode L:
1) CPBEARER or EPGROUP referenced by NODE must be configured on the signaling
plane of the new mode.
2) IPPATH or EPGROUP referenced by NODE must be configured on the user plane of the
new mode.
For details, see section "Configuring Transport Data" in 3900 Series Base Station Initial
Configuration Guide.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
134
Service impact
Services of the original mode are not affected. The new mode can provide services once
the configuration is completed.
Scenari
o
Func
tion
Focus
BBU
Adding a
new mode
to the
original
BBU
Installa
tion
Power
supply
Heat
dissipa
tion
Adding a
new BBU
for mode
transition
Installa
tion
Power
supply
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
135
Equip
ment
RF
module
Scenari
o
SDR RF
module
without
new RF
module
Adding an
RFU
Func
tion
Focus
Heat
dissipa
tion
Installa
tion
N/A
Power
supply
N/A
Heat
dissipa
tion
N/A
Installa
tion
Note:
For the heat dissipation capability, see the section
describing BBU/cabinet specifications.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
136
Equip
ment
Scenari
o
Func
tion
Focus
cable diameter, and circuit breaker, see "Cable diameter
or circuit breaker calculation."
Adding an
RRU
Heat
dissipa
tion
Installa
tion
Power
supply
Transm
ission
equipm
ent
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Original
transmissi
on
equipment
Heat
dissipa
tion
N/A
Installa
tion
N/A
Power
supply
N/A
Heat
dissipa
N/A
137
Equip
ment
Scenari
o
Func
tion
Focus
tion
Others
Adding a
new
transmissi
on
equipment
/Replacing
the
original
transmissi
on
equipment
Installa
tion
Check whether the cabinet has enough room for the new
transmission equipment.
Power
supply
Heat
dissipa
tion
Air
conditione
r in the
equipment
room
Heat
dissipa
tion
Equipment
room
Installa
tion
Material requirement
Check whether a new material is required based on the planning descriptions in this
section.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Version requirement
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
138
None
License requirement
None
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Param
eter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding an
FMU
FMU
Manager Cabinet
No.
MCN
Adding an
FMU
FMU
Manager Subrack
No.
MSRN
Adding an
FMU
FMU
Serial Number
MPN
Adding an
FMU
FMU
Address
ADDR
14
Adding an
FMU
FMU
Smart
Temperature
Control
STC
ENABLE(Enable
)
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding a
TCU
TCU
Manager Cabinet
No.
MCN
Adding a
TCU
TCU
Manager
Subrack No.
MSRN
Adding a
TCU
TCU
Serial Number
MPN
Adding a
TCU
TCU
Address
ADDR
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
139
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding an
EMU
EMU
Manager Cabinet
No.
MCN
Adding an
EMU
EMU
Manager
Subrack No.
MSRN
Adding an
EMU
EMU
Serial Number
MPN
Adding an
EMU
EMU
Address
ADDR
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding a
PMU
PMU
Manager Cabinet
No.
MCN
Adding a
PMU
PMU
Manager
Subrack No.
MSRN
Adding a
PMU
PMU
Serial Number
MPN
Adding a
PMU
PMU
Address
ADDR
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding a
PMU
BATTERY
Battery Type
BTYPE
VRLA_BAT(VR
LA Battery)
Adding a
PMU
BATTERY
Battery 1
Capacity
BC1
30
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
140
Configu
ration
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Parame
ter ID
Example
Value
Equipme
nt
Adding a
CCU
CCU
Manager Cabinet
No.
MCN
Adding a
CCU
CCU
Manager
Subrack No.
MSRN
Adding a
CCU
CCU
Serial Number
MPN
Adding a
CCU
CCU
DirectConnectFl
ag
DCF
YES (Yes)
Adding a
CCU
CCU
Cascade No.
CCN
Adding a
CCU
CCU
Connected RAT
CS
GSM
Service impact
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
141
Mod
ule
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
RF
Multiband
RF
modul
es
except
for
the
RRU3
961.
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
MultiMode
MultiBand
License for
MultiBand RF
Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RF
BAND01
Per
band
RF
MultiMode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(UMTS)
MultiMode
MultiBand
License for
MultiBand RF
Module
(UMTS)
(Per Band
per RRU)
82205398
LQW9RF
BAND01
Per
band
RF
First Mode
First Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
MultiMode
MultiBand
License for
MultiBand RF
Module
(LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per
RRU)
82205382
LLT1MM
LMBRM0
1
Per
band
RF
MultiMode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(LTE FDD)
MultiMode
MultiBand
License for
MultiBand RF
Module
(LTE
FDD) (Per
Band per
82205382
LLT1MM
LMBRM0
1
Per
band
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
142
Do
mai
n
Mod
ule
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
RRU)
RF
Must
be
purch
ased
for
the
RRU3
961 if
both
the
800
MHz
and
900
MHz
freque
ncy
bands
are
used.
RF
800M/900
M Multi
Band
license
RF
800M/900
M Multi
Band
license
82204034
LLT1RFM
B01
Per
band
per
RRU
RF
GU
Nonblade
modul
e
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Mode
license
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
82201199
LQW9MB
TSRF02
Per
sector
Blade
&AA
U
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U
The
number of
RF Units
with
GSM/UM
TS dual
mode
function
enabled
82201199
LQW9MB
TSRF02
Per
sector
Nonblade
modul
e
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license(per
Sector)
82201472
LLT1GLD
M01
Per
sector
Blade
&AA
U
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license(per
82201472
LLT1GLD
M01
Per
sector
RF
GL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
143
Do
mai
n
RF
UL
RF
GUL
Mod
ule
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Blade&AA
U
Sector)
Nonblade
modul
e
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
82201473
LLT1ULD
M01
Per
sector
Blade
&AA
U
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U
UMTS/LT
E Dual
Mode
license(per
Sector)
82201473
LLT1ULD
M01
Per
sector
Nonblade
modul
e
RF
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Mode
license +
RF
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license
NA
NA
NA
Per
sector
U+L
N/A
NA
NA
Per
sector
U+L
or
RF
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Mode
license +
RF
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license
Blade
&AA
U
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U+
GSM/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U
or
GSM/UMT
S Dual
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
144
Do
mai
n
Mod
ule
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U+
UMTS/LTE
Dual Mode
license for
Blade&AA
U
MPT
Multi
mode
coMPT
UMPT
Multi Mode
License(GS
M)
UMPT
Multi
Mode
License
(GSM)(per
UMPT)
82204202
LGB3UM
ML01
Per
UMPT
MPT
Multi
mode
coMPT
UMPT
Multi Mode
License(U
MTS)
UMPT
Multi
Mode
License
(UMTS)
(per
UMPT)
82203981
LQW9GU
DM01
Per
UMPT
MPT
Multi
mode
coMPT
UMPT
MultiMode
license
(LTE FDD)
UMPT
Multi
Mode
License
(per
UMPT)
(FDD)
82204259
LLT1UM
ML01
Per
UMPT
MPT
Multi
mode
coMPT
UMPT
Multi Mode
License
(per
UMPT)
(TDD)
UMPT
Multi
Mode
License
(per
UMPT)
(TDD)
82204285
LLT1TUM
ML01
Per
UMPT
Clock
Clock
sharin
g
Multi-mode
BS
Common
Reference
Clock(eNo
deB)
FunctionLTELLT1MCR
C01-Multimode BS
Common
Reference
Clock(eNo
deB)(Per
81201529
LLT1MCR
C01
Per
eNode
B
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
145
Do
mai
n
Mod
ule
Type
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
eNodeB)
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
First-Mode
license
(GSM)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(GSM)
(Per
Module)
82204551
LGMIUB
BP
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(GSM)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(GSM)
(Per
Module)
82204551
LGMIUB
BP
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
First-Mode
license
(UMTS)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UB
PDM01
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(UMTS)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(UMTS)
82204657
LQW9UB
PDM01
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
First-Mode
license
(LTE FDD)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(FDD)
82205382
LLT1MM
LMBRM0
1
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(FDD)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(FDD)
82205382
LLT1MM
LMBRM0
1
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
First-Mode
license
(LTE TDD)
UBBP
MultiMode
license
(TDD)
82204849
LLT1TUB
MML01
Per
UBBP
Baseb
and
Cobaseb
and
UBBP
MultiMode
UBBP
MultiMode
82204849
LLT1TUB
MML01
Per
UBBP
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
146
Do
mai
n
Trans
missi
on
Mod
ule
Type
Cotrans
missi
on
License
Control
Item
Name
(SBOM)
License
Control
Item
Name
(BBOM)
license
(TDD)
license
(TDD)
IP-Based
Multi-mode
CoTransmissio
n on BS
side(eNode
B)
FunctionLTELLT1IPM
CT01-IPBased
Multimode CoTransmissi
on on BS
side(eNode
B)(Per
eNodeB)
License
BBOM
License
Abbrevi
ation
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
81201528
LLT1IPM
CT01
Per
eNode
B
Module
Type
License
SBOM
Sales
Unit
Mod
e
Clock
Clock
sharing
Multi-mode BS Common
Reference Clock(GBTS)
88030QUK
Per BTS
Clock
Clock
sharing
Multi-mode BS Common
Reference Clock(NodeB)
88030QUU
Per
NodeB
Clock
Clock
sharing
Multi-mode BS Common
Reference Clock(eNodeB)
88030QUW
Per
eNodeB
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUG
Per BTS
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
NodeB
Transmi
ssion
Cotransmissi
on
88030QUR
Per
eNodeB
In GBSS R15.0, the control mechanism of BTS license is changed. The main change is that
eGBTS controls those features quoted in BTS independently. Before enable or use these
features, GTS should allocate sufficient licenses on U2000 eGBTS License Management
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
147
View. Otherwise, these features cannot be enabled and CS/PS transaction may even be
infected. The following table describes how to allocate license of those BTS features for each
eGBTS.
1.
The Features Included by eGBTS License File But Not Supported by the eGBTS
Site
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GBTS
Suppo
rted
eGBTS
Suppor
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly
built eGBTS
High Power
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
TRU which
works as
Multitransceivers
Resource of
the 3rd
generation
BTS (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
BBU Carrier
Capacity
License (per
TRX)
per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
GBFD115901
PBT(Power
Boost
Technology)
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
GBFD115902
Transmit
Diversity (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
BTS3900B
Transceiver
Resource (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
No
License = 0
2.
Multi-Carrier
60 W High
Power License
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Multi-Carrier
80 W High
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Power License
(per TRX)
TRU which
works as
Multitransceivers
Resource of
3900 (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Non-SubSite scene:
License = the number of
logical TRXs of eGBTS
the number of include GSM
TRX's Boards.
SubSite scene(Supported
begin eGBTS R16.0):
(1) International and China
Unicom: License = the
number of logical TRXs of
eGBTS * the number of
location groups the
number of RXUs from all
location groups.
(2) China Mobile:
License = the number of
logical TRXs of eGBTS
the number of RXUs from
the most RXUs location
group.
Related BSC MML:
LST GTRX;
LST BTSLOCGRPE;
Related eGBTS MML:
LST
GTRXGROUPSECTOREQ
M LST SECTOREQM
MRFD211801
Multi-mode
Dynamic
Power
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
Power Sharing Type set to
GUPWRSHR (GU Power
Sharing).
Related eGBTS MML:
LST GBTSPWRSHRGRP;
MRFD211703
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
2.0 MHz
Central
Frequency
point
separation
between GSM
and UMTS
mode(GSM)
(per Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
MRFD211804
GSM Power
Control on
Interference
Frequency for
GU Small
Frequency
gap(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
MRFD211505
Bandwidth
sharing of
MBTS Multimode CoTransmission(
GBTS) (per
Site)
Per Site
Yes
Yes
MRFD211602
Multi-mode
BS Common
IPSec(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Yes
Yes
MRFD211802
GSM and
UMTS
Dynamic
Spectrum
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
Yes
Yes
License = 1 if Spectrum
Sharing Allowed of eGBTS
set to YES.
Dynamic MA
for GU
Dynamic
Spectrum
Sharing(GSM)
(per Site)
per
BTS
MRFD211803
Yes
Yes
Yes
License = 1 if in a eGBTS,
at least one channel's FH
Index Used After Frequency
Spectrum Sharing set to
value in range [0,63].
Related BSC MML:
LST GTRXCHANHOP;
MRFD211806
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
Power Sharing Type set to
GLPWRSHR (GL Power
Sharing).
Related eGBTS MML:
LST GBTSPWRSHRGRP;
MRFD211901
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Multi-RAT
Carrier Joint
Shutdown(GB
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
150
to ON.
Related BSC MML:
LST GCELLSOFT
GBFD116602
IPSec Bypass
(per Site)
Per
BTS
No
Yes
UMPT MultiMode
License(GSM)
(per UMPT)
Per
UMPT
No
Yes
Antenna
Intermodulatio
n Performance
Detection (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Extended
Spectrum Scan
(per TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
3.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
151
Feature
ID
License
Descripti
on
Sal
e
Uni
t
GBTS
Supp
orted
eGBTS
Suppor
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly
built eGBTS
GBFD151202
BTS IP
Active
Performance
Measuremen
t (per Site)
Per
BTS
No
Yes
license = 1 if eGBTS's
TWAMPCLIENT or
TWAMPRESPONDER
function is enabled.
Related BTS MML:
LST TWAMPCLIENT
LST TWAMPRESPONDER
4.
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
SubSite
Solution
License (per
Module)
Per
Module
Yes
Yes
RFU co-cell
Solution
License (per
Module)
Per
Module
Yes
Yes
GBFD115903
4-Way
Receiver
Diversity (per
TRX)
Per
TRX
Yes
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
152
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
LST GTRXGROUP
-
GBFD160209
GBFD160210
Per
Module
IPSec
redundancy
among multiSeGWs (per
BTS)
Per
BTS
BTS
supporting
PKI
redundancy
(per BTS)
Per
BTS
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
No
Yes
MRFD261103
AAS RAT
Specific
Tilting (GSM)
(Per RU)
Per RU
No
Yes
Not
Commer
cial
AAS Virtual
Four Uplink
Channels for
GSM (per
RU)
Per RU
No
Yes
5.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
153
Featu
re ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Su
pp
ort
ed
eG
BTS
Sup
por
ted
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD170205
GTMUb
SingleOM
(Per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
6.
Featur
e ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GB
TS
Sup
por
ted
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD171205
BTS
Supporting
Multi-Carrier
PKI (per
BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
GBFD171206
BTS
Supporting
IPSec
Redirection
(per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
Multi-Mode
Multi-Band
License for
Multi-Band
RF Module
(GSM) (Per
Band per
RRU)
per
Band
per
RRU
Yes
Yes
7.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
154
Featur
e ID
License
Descriptio
n
Sale
Unit
GBT
S
Sup
por
ted
eG
BT
S
Su
pp
ort
ed
License allocating
guidance for newly built
eGBTS
GBFD181202
BTS
Supporting
Digital
Certificate
Whitelist
Management
(Per BTS)
per
BTS
No
Yes
Material Name
Quantity
RF
RRU/RFU
Determined based
on the plan
CPRI high-speed
cable
Determined based
on the plan
Determined based
on the plan
Optical module
Determined based
on the plan
Determined based
on the plan
RF interconnection
cable
Determined based
on the plan
Required by the
GSM, multimode,
and UMTS RF
modules
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Remarks
155
Material Type
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Antenna
Feeder
Jumper
SBT
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Required on the
antenna side when
the following
conditions are met:
RET is configured
for the new
mode.
No TMA is
configured.
TMA
Configured as
required by the
network plan.
RCU
AISG cable
Required for
connecting to the
SBT or TMA when
RET is required. The
lengths of the AISG
cable vary with
scenarios.
156
Material Type
MPT
Material Name
Quantity
Remarks
Combiner
UMPT(L)/LMPT
Determined based
on the plan
An LTE main
control board is
added.
Use a newly
delivered board
because such boards
work in the
maintenance mode
by default. If you do
not use a newly
delivered board, this
board may not work
in the maintenance
mode, and a false
alarm may be
generated during
mode transition and
services of the newly
deployed mode may
be interrupted.
UMPT(U)/WMPT
Determined based
on the plan
A UMTS main
control board is
added.
Use a newly
delivered board
because such boards
work in the
maintenance mode
by default. If you do
not use a newly
delivered board, this
board may not work
in the maintenance
mode, and a false
alarm may be
generated during
mode transition and
services of the newly
deployed mode may
be interrupted.
GTMU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Determined based
Material Type
BBU
interconnection and
BBU
Material Name
BBU subrack
Quantity
Remarks
on the plan
board is added.
Determined based
on the plan
Transmission cable
Some
Some
BBU
interconnection
through
UCIU+UMPT: One
optical fiber and two
optical modules are
required for BBU
interconnection.
BBU
interconnection
through
UMPT+UMPT: A
cable is required for
BBU
interconnection.
UCIU
Determined based
on the plan
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
158
Domain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Paramete
r Name
Para
met
er ID
Value
(Examp
le)
CM
E
Ty
pe
RF
module
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Cabinet No.
CN
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Subrack No.
SRN
60
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Slot No.
SN
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU type
RT
MRRU
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU Topo
Position
TP
TRUNK
(in the
main chain
or ring)
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU
Chain/Ring
No.
RCN
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RRU Position
PS
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
RF Unit
Working
Mode
RS
GL
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
RX channels
RXN
UM
RF
Adding an
RXU
RRU
Number of
TX channels
TXN
UM
RF
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Link
No.
LN
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Cabinet
No.
CN
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Subrack
No.
SRN
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
SN
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Cabinet
No.
UPCN
Equ
ipm
ent
BBU
interconne
ction
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
159
Domain
Clock
GBTS
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Paramete
r Name
Para
met
er ID
Value
(Examp
le)
CM
E
Ty
pe
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper
Subrack No.
UPSR
N
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Slot
No.
UPSN
Equ
ipm
ent
Root BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Port
No.
UPPT
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Link
No.
LN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Cabinet
No.
CN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Local Subrack
No.
SRN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
SN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Cabinet
No.
UPCN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper
Subrack No.
UPSR
N
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Slot
No.
UPSN
Equ
ipm
ent
Leaf BBU
mode
CTRLLNK
Upper Port
No.
UPPT
Equ
ipm
ent
Original
mode/new
mode
BTSCLK
Clock Type
ClkTy
pe
PEER_CL
K
Equ
ipm
ent
BTSCLK
Peer Mode
STAN
DAR
D
Set this
parameter
to the
mode of
the
Equ
ipm
ent
160
Domain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Paramete
r Name
Para
met
er ID
Value
(Examp
le)
CM
E
Ty
pe
reference
clock.
Clock
Original
mode/new
mode
CLKMODE
Clock
Working
Mode
MOD
E
Set this
parameter
to
MANUAL
(Manual).
Equ
ipm
ent
CLKMODE
Selected
Clock Source
CLKS
RC
Set this
parameter
to
PEERCL
K(Peer
Clock).
Equ
ipm
ent
PEERCLK
Peer Clock
No.
PN
Set this
parameter
to 0.
Equ
ipm
ent
PEERCLK
Peer Standard
PS
Set this
parameter
to the
mode of
the
reference
clock.
Equ
ipm
ent
MPT
Original
mode/new
mode
Working
Mode
Working
Mode
WM
Set this
parameter
to
CONCUR
RENT(Co
ncurrent).
Equ
ipm
ent
Baseband
Original
mode/new
mode
BBP
Base Band
Work
Standard
BBW
S
Determine
d by the
UBBP
configurati
on plan
Equ
ipm
ent
Original
mode/new
mode
MDU
Base Band
Work
Standard
BBW
S
Determine
d by the
mode
planned
for the
UMDU
Equ
ipm
ent
New-mode
main control
board
E1T1
Transmiss
ion
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Tran
smis
sion
161
Domain
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Paramete
r Name
New-mode
main control
board
ETHPORT
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
PPPLNK
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
MPGRP
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
MPLNK
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
TUNNEL
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
DEVIP
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
IPRT
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
OMCH
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
SCTPLNK
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
IPPATH
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
EPGROUP
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
and
USERPLAN
EHOST (in
end point
configuration
mode)
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
USERPLAN
EPEER
Tran
smis
Para
met
er ID
Value
(Examp
le)
CM
E
Ty
pe
162
Domain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Paramete
r Name
board
Para
met
er ID
Value
(Examp
le)
CM
E
Ty
pe
sion
New-mode
main control
board
SCTPHOST
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
SCTPPEER
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
DHCPRELA
YSWITCH
Tran
smis
sion
New-mode
main control
board
DHCPSVRIP
Tran
smis
sion
Originalmode main
control board
TUNNEL
Tran
smis
sion
Originalmode main
control board
DEVIP
Tran
smis
sion
Originalmode main
control board
IPRT
Tran
smis
sion
How to Obtain
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
http://support.huawei.com/carrier/navi#col=software&path=PBI17851894/PBI1-7854240/PBI1-7275801/PBI1-19953556/PBI113761
http://support.huawei.com/carrier/navi#col=software&path=PBI17851894/PBI1-7854240/PBI1-7275801/PBI1-19953557/PBI113751
163
Tool Name
How to Obtain
&SRANModule_V**
*R***C**SPC***.zi
p
Data planning
template for co-MPT
reconstruction
configuration data
conversion
NOTE
Use the data planning template for the corresponding SRAN version during
co-MPT reconstruction.
Standalone CME
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
164
This section describes mode transition using the MO involved in each domain for mode
transition planning based on application scenarios as an example. These mode transition
examples can be used as references for customizing the CME template during data creation.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
165
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-1 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
166
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
LTE S1/1/1 (1x5 MHz),
2T2R
BBU
RF typology
Transmission scheme
Co-transmission through
panel interconnection for
GSM and UMTS, IP over
Ethernet
Co-transmission through
UMPT backplane, IP over
Ethernet
Clock networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Globa
l
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
CnOperator
502
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
IPCLK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
167
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
Mode
FREQ
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL_PRC
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Link No.
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Protocol Type
PTP
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Server IPv4
170.179.179.34
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Client IPv4
160.70.7.10
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
LTE
SUBRACK
Cabinet No.
Cabinet No.: 0
Subrack No.
Subrack No.: 1
Subrack Type
Type: BBU3900
MPT
MPT
Cabinet No.
MPT
MPT
Subrack No.
MPT
MPT
Slot No.
MPT
MPT
Board Type
UMPT
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
baseband
processing board.
RF module
RRU
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Configure an RRU
on the new RRU
chain. The subrack
No. of the RRU
must be different
from that of a
configured RRU
and the working
mode of the RRU
must be set to
GSM_LTE.
Subrack No. is
set to 63, 64, and
65 for the GL
RRUs.
Feeder
RET
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RET
RET Type
SINGLE_RET
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Polar Type
DUAL
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Antenna Scenario
REGULAR
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Cabinet No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Subrack No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Subunit No.
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Connect to the
following:
0\63\0 R0A0\63\0 R0B
0\64\0 R0A0\64\0 R0B
0\65\0 R0A-
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
169
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
0\65\0 R0B
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.13
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.13
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
170
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
160.70.7.13
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
255.255.255.0
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0\1\7
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.13
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
TUNNEL
Configure a
tunnel between
the UMPT and
GTMU boards,
and a tunnel
between the
UMPT and
WMPT boards
for backplane
transmission.
Both tunnels are
for downlink
transmission.
Transmission
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPRT
Route Index
Configure eight
IP routes to the
following items:
U2000, clock,
SG-W, MME,
BSC, RNC,
GSM tunnel,
and UMTS
171
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
tunnel.
Set the route
type to Next
Hop for all the
IP routes except
for the two
routes to
tunnels and
specify the IP
addresses as
planned.
Set the route
type to IF and
port type to
TUNNEL for
IP routes to
tunnels.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Transmission
CTRLLNK
Transmission
ETHPORT
Port No.
0 and 1
Transmission
ETHPORT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
UMPT in
subrack 1.
Transmission
ETHPORT
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
ETHPORT
Port Attribute
Two values:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
172
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
COPPER
FIBER
Transmission
DHCPSVRIP
DHCP Server
IP Address
Transmission
DHCPRELAYS
WITCH
DHCP Relay
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
OMCH AutoEstablishment
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
Vlanscan
Switch
DISABLE
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Add three
sectors.
They use the
following
antennas:
0:
0,63,0,0;0,63,0,
1
1:
0,64,0,0;0,64,0,
1
2:
0,65,0,0;0,65,0,
1
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
173
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
0:
0,63,0,0,3,0;0,6
3,0,1,3,0
1:
0,64,0,0,3,0;0,6
4,0,1,3,0
2:
0,65,0,0,3,0;0,6
5,0,1,3,0
Radio
Cell
Radio
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Type
ULDL
Radio
BASEBANDE
QM
UMTS UL
Demodulation
DEM_4_CHAN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
174
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Mode
Radio
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Board
0,1,3
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Configurati
on Object
MOC
CPRI-based
topology
GSM
BTSRXUCHAI
N
Configure three
RRU chains on
optical ports 3,
4, and 5 on the
GTMU.
CPRI-based
topology
BTSRXUBRD
Added one
MRRU to
position 1 of
each of the
newly added
three chains.
RF module
BTSRXUBP
Working
Standard
GSM_AND_LT
E
Note that the
working mode
of the new RF
module must be
set to GL.
Radio
GCELL
Radio
TRXINFO
Configure two
TRXs in each
cell using the
main and
diversity RX
channels.
Radio
TRXBIND2PH
YBRD
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Freq. Band
175
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
BTSDEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINTERF
ACE
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.241
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS
Communication
Type
LOGICIP
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS IP
88.200.8.241
Transmission
BTSIP
BSC IP
26.14.1.1
Transmission
BTSESN
BTS Interface
Board Bar Code
1
21021127226T
BA915704
Transmission
BTSESN
OM Bear Board
BACKBOARD
Transmission
BTSTUNNEL
--
From the
GTMU to
UMPT (LTE),
the tunnel No.
is 0.
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination IP
Address
26.14.1.1 (BSC)
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Index
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Type
OUTIF
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the ports
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Interface Type
TUNNEL
Transmission
BTSCLK
Clock Type
PEER_CLK
Transmission
BTSCLK
Peer Mode
LTE
Transmission
IPRT
Subrack No
Transmission
IPRT
Slot No
14
Transmission
IPRT
Destination IP
address
88.200.8.241
Transmission
IPRT
Gateway
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
176
Domain
Configurati
on Object
Transmission
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
IPRT
Forward route
address
26.14.0.1
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Clock
UMTS
PEERCLK
Clock
PEERCLK
Peer Standard
LTE
Clock
TASM
Clock Working
Mode
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock Source
No.
Clock
TASM
Selected Clock
Source
PEERCLK
Clock
TASM
Clock
Synchronizatio
n Mode
FREQ
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL-SSU-B
Configurat
ion Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
UMTS
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the WMPT
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINT
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.242
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Domain
Configurat
ion Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
address (base
station
controller side)
of an SCTP link
to LTE IP
addresses.
Transmission
IPPATH
Transmission
OMCH
Transmission
TUNNEL
The tunnel
starts from the
WMPT to the
UMPT and the
direction is
uplink.
Transmission
IPRT
Configure IP
routes to the
U2000, RNC,
and UMPT.
Remove the
clock route.
Local IP
Change it to an
address on the
LTE side.
Route Type: IF
Port Type:
TUNNEL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
178
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
179
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-10 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
180
Item
BBU
Before Transition
After Transition
1T2R
One BBU
One BBU
GSM and LTE using the
same BBU and GSM
configured with UBRI
RF typology
Transmission scheme
Clock networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
CnOperator
502
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
IPCLK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
181
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
Mode
FREQ
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL_PRC
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Link No.
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Protocol Type
PTP
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Server IPv4
170.179.179.34
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Client IPv4
160.70.7.10
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Domain
Globa
l
APPLICATION
Application
Maintenance Mode
INSTALL
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Port No.
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
MPT
LTE
MPT
Cabinet No.
MPT
MPT
Subrack No.
MPT
MPT
Slot No.
MPT
MPT
Board Type
LMPT
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
182
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet No.
Cabinet Type
Cabinet Type:
BTS3900
Equipment
SUBRACK
Cabinet No.
Cabinet No.: 0
Subrack No.
Subrack 0:
BBU3900
Subrack Type
RRUCHAIN
RF
RFU
RF
RFU
TRUCK
RF
RFU
0-5
RF
RFU
RRU Position
RF
RFU
RRU type
MRFU
RF
RFU
RF Unit Working
Mode
GL
RF
RFU
Number of RX
channels
RF
RFU
Number of TX
channels
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RET
RET Type
SINGLE_RET
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
183
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Polar Type
DUAL
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Antenna Scenario
REGULAR
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Cabinet No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Subrack No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
0, 2, and 4
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Subunit No.
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Connect Port 1
Cabinet No.
Connect to the
following:
1\4\0 R0A- 1\4\1
R0A
1\4\2 R0A- 1\4\3
R0A
1\4\4 R0A- 1\4\5
R0A
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
The main
control board
provides
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.10
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
125.120.120.1
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
184
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Address
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R8
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
Base Station
Transport
Data\OM
Plane\*OmCh
LocalIP
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
Base Station
Transport
Data/OM
Plane/*OmCh
LocalMask
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
185
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
Base Station
Transport
Data\OM
Plane\OmCh
DstIP
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
Base Station
Transport
Data\OM
Plane\OmCh
DstMask
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.10
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
TUNNEL
Transmission
IPRT
The tunnel
starts from the
UMPT to the
GTMU and the
direction is
downlink.
Route Index
Configure six IP
routes: for
OMCH, for
IPCLK, to the
GBTS, S-GW,
MME, and
BSC,
respectively.
Set the route
type to Next
Hop for all the
IP routes except
for the two
routes to the
GBTS and
specify the IP
addresses as
planned.
Set the route
type to IF and
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
186
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
port type to
TUNNEL for
IP routes to
tunnels.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Transmission
DHCPSVRIP
DHCP Server
IP Address
Transmission
DHCPRELAYS
WITCH
DHCP Relay
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
OMCH AutoEstablishment
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
Vlanscan
Switch
DISABLE
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
187
Domain
Antenna and
feeder
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
0:
1,4,0,0,3,0;1,4,1
,0,3,0
1:
1,4,2,0,3,0;1,4,3
,0,3,0
2:
1,4,4,0,3,0;1,4,5
,0,3,0
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
188
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
through 2.
Baseband
equipment:
share equipment
0.
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment ID
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Type
ULDL
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
UMTS UL
Demodulation
Mode
DEM_4_CHAN
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Board
0, 0, 3
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Equipment
GSM
BTSBRD
Add a UBRI to
slot 2
(0_0_2_1).
Equipment
BTSCABINET
Cabinet No.
Add a BTS3900
to cabinet 1.
CPRI-based
topology
BTSRXUCHAI
N
RF
BTSRXUBRD
Added one
MRFU to
position 1 of
each of the
newly added six
chains.
RF
BTSRXUBP
Working
Standard
GSM_AND_LT
E
Note that the
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
189
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
working mode
of the new RF
module must be
set to GL.
RF
TRXBIND2PH
YBRD
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
BTSDEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINTERF
ACE
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
*Port No.
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Index
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.37
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Mask
255.255.255.0
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
BTS Inner IP
Switch
NO
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS
Communication
Type
LOGICIP
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS IP
88.200.8.37
Transmission
BTSIP
BSC IP
40.13.3.200
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS MultiIP
Switch
NO
Transmission
BTSESN
BTS Interface
Board Bar Code
1
21021127229T
AB020269
Transmission
BTSESN
OM Bear Board
BACKBOARD
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
190
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BTSTUNNEL
The tunnel
starts from the
GTMU to the
UMPT and is
used for
interconnection
through panel
transmission.
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Index
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination IP
Address
40.13.3.200
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination
Address Mask
255.255.255.25
5
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Type
OUTIF
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Interface Type
TUNNEL
Transmission
BTSCLK
Clock Type
PEER_CLK
Transmission
BTSCLK
Peer Mode
LTE
Transmission
IPRT
Subrack No.
Transmission
IPRT
Slot No.
14
Transmission
IPRT
Destination IP
address
Set the
destination IP
addresses to the
IP addresses of
the GBTS:
88.200.8.37
160.70.7.10
Transmission
IPRT
Destination
address mask
255.255.255.25
5
Transmission
IPRT
Gateway
Transmission
IPRT
Forward route
address
40.13.3.1
Transmission
IPRT
Priority
HIGH
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
191
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
192
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-17 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
BBU
One BBU
RF typology
Chain topology
Transmission scheme
Independent transmission
through panel, IP over
Ethernet
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
193
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Ethernet
Clock networking
IP reference clock
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 UMPT data configuration
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Clock
UMTS
IPCLKLNK
Link No.
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Protocol Type
PTP
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
of the main
control board
Clock
IPCLKLNK
Server IPv4
170.179.179.3
4
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
IPCLK
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
Mode
FREQ
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL_PRC
Global
UNODEBMNT
MODE
Maintenance Mode
INSTALL
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Equipment
MBSC
NE
Network Element
Name
U_Transition_
100
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
194
Domain
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Equipment
NE
Product Type
BTS3900_WC
DMA
Equipment
NE
NodeB Template
BTS3900_WC
DMA_IP
RAN_2Channels
Demodulation
_3Sector
Equipment
NODEB
RNC Name
MBSC252
Equipment
NODEB
NodeB ID
44
Equipment
NODEB
Subrack No.
Equipment
NODEB
Slot No.
Equipment
NODEB
Subsystem No.
Equipment
NODEB
IP_TRANS
Equipment
NODEB
SUPPORT
Equipment
NODEB
SINGLEHOS
T
Equipment
NODEB
Sharing Type Of
NodeB
DEDICATED
Equipment
NODEB
Cn Operator Index
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
Subrack No.
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
Slot No.
14
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
Port No.
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
IP address index
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
Local IP address
26.14.1.1
Transmissio
n
ETHIP
Subnet mask
255.255.0.0
Transmissio
n
NCP
SCTP
Transmissio
n
NCP
Port No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configur
ation
Object
195
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Transmissio
n
NCP
SCTP
Transmissio
n
NCP
1001
Transmissio
n
NCP
1002
Transmissio
n
ADJNODE
Adjacent Node ID
2340
Transmissio
n
ADJNODE
U_Transition_
100
Transmissio
n
ADJNODE
Transport Type
IP
Transmissio
n
IPCLKLNK
Client IPv4
26.14.7.15
Radio
ULOCELL
Radio
Cell
Transmissio
n
SCTPLNK
Application type
Add two
SCTP links.
Both peer IP
addresses are
26.14.7.15.
Peer ports are
port 1024 and
port 1025.
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
Adjacent Node ID
2340
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
IP path ID
1
2
3
4
Transmissio
n
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPPATH
Interface Type
IUB
196
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
Transport Type
IP
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
IP path type
EF
AF43
AF23
AF13
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
Local IP address
26.14.1.1
Transmissio
n
IPPATH
Peer IP address
26.14.7.15
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
NodeB Name
U_Transition_
100
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
000000
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
6144
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
6144
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
HSUPA Credit
Consume Type
MBR
Transmissio
n
NODEBALGO
PARA
NodeB Algorithm
Enhancement Switch
Radio
CELLLDR
BERateRed
Radio
CELLLDR
NoAct
Radio
CELLLDR
NoAct
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
DL LDR Eleventh
Action
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
DL LDR-BE rate
reduction RAB number
Radio
CELLLDR
DL LDR un-ctrl RT
Qos re-nego RAB num
BERateRed
Radio
CELLLDR
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
197
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
UL LDR seventh
action
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
Radio
CELLLDR
UL LDR-BE rate
reduction RAB number
Radio
CELLLDR
UL LDR un-ctrl RT
Qos re-nego RAB num
SF8
Radio
CELLLDR
UL PS should be HO
user number
SF8
Radio
CELLLDR
UL LDR-AMR rate
reduction RAB number
SF8
Radio
NODEBOLC
Radio
NODEBOLC
Radio
NODEBOLC
MBMS Services
Number Released
Radio
NODEBOLC
Sequence of User
Release
MBMS_REL
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
MPT
UMTS
MPT
Cabinet No.
MPT
MPT
Subrack No.
MPT
MPT
Slot No.
MPT
MPT
Board Type
WMPT
MPT
MPT
Enable Flag
ENABLE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
198
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
WBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment ID
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Type
ULDL
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
UMTS UL
Demodulation
Mode
DEM_2_CHAN
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment
Board
0, 0, 3
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
Three RRU
chains are
connected to
three optical
ports 0, 2, and 4
on the baseband
processing
board.
RF
RFU
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
UMTS
NODEBPATH
PATH ID
Four paths 1
through 4.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
199
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Local ports are
port 1024 and
port 1025.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Transmission
IUBCP
Add two CP
bearers with two
corresponding
SCTP links.
Port Type
NCP
CCP
Transmission
IUBCP
CP Port No.
/
0
Transmission
IUBCP
Belong Flag
MASTER
Transmission
IUBCP
CPBear ID
2
3
Transmission
IPPATH
Four IP paths.
The DSCPs are
46, 38, 22, and
14.
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
26.14.7.15
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
Base Station
Transport
Data/OM
Plane/*OmCh
LocalMask
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
IP address:
160.70.7.10
Type: ETH
Transmission
NTPCP
IPv4 Address
of NTP Server
10.141.142.22
Transmission
NTPCP
IP Mode
IPV4
Transmission
NTPCP
Synchronizatio
n Period(min)
10
Transmission
NTPCP
Port Number
123
Transmission
NTPCP
Authentication
Mode
PLAIN
Transmission
NTPCP
Master Flag
Master
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
200
Domain
Configurati
on Object
Transmission
MOC
Parameter
IPRT
Recommen
ded Value
Add two IP
routes.
Destination IP
addresses:
170.179.179.34
10.0.0.0
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
UMTS
SECTOR
Sector Antenna
0, 4, 0, R0A; 0,
4, 0, R0B
0, 4, 2, R0A; 0,
4, 2, R0B
0, 4, 4, R0A; 0,
4, 4, R0B
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
RF
GSM
BTSRXUBP
Working
Standard
GSM_AND_U
MTS
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
201
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
202
Table 4-24 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
BBU
One BBU
RF typology
Chain topology
Transmission scheme
Clock networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Globa
l
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
CnOperator
502
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
203
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Server
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
PEERCLK
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Port No.
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
LTE
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Add an RRU
chain on optical
port 0 on the
baseband
processing board.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Add three
cascaded RRUs to
the new RRU
chain.
204
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Add an LMPT
to provide
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.12
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the LMPT.
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configurati
on Object
205
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
S1Interface
Control Mode
MANUAL_MO
DE
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the LMPT.
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.12
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
IPRT
Route Index
Configure three
IP routes: one
for OMCH, one
to the S-GW,
and one to the
MME.
OMCH
TO SG-W
TO MME
Set the route
type to Next
Hop and
specify the IP
addresses as
planned.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
206
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
207
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
RF
UMTS
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
UL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
208
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-30 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
209
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
MHz), 2T2R
BBU
RF typology
Transmission scheme
Co-transmission through
panel interconnection for
GSM and UMTS, IP over
Ethernet
Co-transmission through
UMPT backplane
interconnection, IP over
Ethernet
Clock networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Global
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATO
R_PRIMARY
CnOperator
502
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization
Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
IPCLK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
210
Domain
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recomme
nded
Value
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
Mode
FREQ
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL_PRC
Equipment
EQUIPMENT
Maintenance Mode
INSTALL
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Equipment
LTE
SUBRACK
Cabinet No.
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack No.
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack Type
BBU3900
MPT
MPT
Cabinet No.
MPT
MPT
Subrack No.
MPT
MPT
Slot No.
MPT
MPT
Board Type
UMPT
MPT
MPT
Enable Flag
ENABLE
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Equipment
BBUFAN
Cabinet No.
Equipment
BBUFAN
Subrack No.
Equipment
BBUFAN
Slot No.
16
Equipment
PEU
Cabinet No.
Equipment
PEU
Subrack No.
Equipment
PEU
Slot No.
19
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configure three
RRU chains to
optical ports 0
through 2 on the
LBBP board.
211
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
RF
RRU
BBU
interconnection
CTRLLNK
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Configure an
RRU on the
new RRU
chain. The RRU
working mode
must be set to
GUL. The GUL
RRU subracks
must be
assigned with
numbers 60, 61,
and 62.
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
ETHPORT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
UMPT in
subrack 1.
Transmission
ETHPORT
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
UMPT in
subrack 1.
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configurati
on Object
212
Domain
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.10
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
TUNNEL
Configure a
tunnel between
the UMPT and
GTMU boards,
and a tunnel
between the
UMPT and
WMPT boards
for backplane
transmission.
Transmission
IPRT
Configure
routes from the
base station to
the U2000,
BSC, RNC,
MME, S-GW,
IP clock, the
GTMU board,
and the WMPT
board. The
routes to the
U2000, BSC,
RNC, MME,
and S-GW are
panel routes,
and two tunnels
must be
configured for
the transmission
through
backplane for
GTMU and
WMPT boards.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
The main
control board in
subrack 1
provides
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.10
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
2913
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Configurati
on Object
213
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Port No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
255.255.255.0
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.10
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
214
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Transmission
DHCPSVRIP
DHCP Server
IP Address
Transmission
DHCPRELAYS
WITCH
DHCP Relay
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
OMCH AutoEstablishment
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
Vlanscan
Switch
DISABLE
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
215
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
0:
0, 60, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 60, 0, 1, 3, 0
1:
0, 61, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 61, 0, 1, 3, 0
2:
0, 62, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 62, 0, 1, 3, 0
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
216
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
equipment:
share equipment
0.
Configurati
on Object
MOC
CPRI-based
topology
GSM
BTSRXUCHAI
N
RF
BTSRXUBP
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Set the Access
Type column in
the BTS RXU
Chain area to
PEERPORT
and the Head
Board No.
column to that
of the WBBP in
slot 3.
Working
Standard
GSM_AND_U
MTS_AND_LT
E
Note: The
working mode
the RF module
must be
changed to
GUL.
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
BTSDEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINTERF
ACE
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.236
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS
Communication
Type
LOGICIP
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
217
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS IP
88.200.8.236
Transmission
BTSIP
BSC IP
25.14.1.1
Transmission
BTSESN
BTS Interface
Board Bar Code
1
21021127226T
A9025307
Transmission
BTSESN
OM Bear Board
BACKBOARD
Transmission
BTSTUNNEL
--
From the
GTMU to
UMPT (LTE),
the tunnel No.
is 0.
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination IP
Address
25.14.1.1 (BSC)
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Index
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Type
OUTIF
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the ports
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Interface Type
TUNNEL
Transmission
BTSCLK
Clock Type
PEER_CLK
Transmission
BTSCLK
Peer Mode
LTE
Transmission
IPRT
Subrack No
Transmission
IPRT
Slot No
14
Transmission
IPRT
Destination IP
address
88.200.8.236
Transmission
IPRT
Gateway
Transmission
IPRT
Forward route
address
25.14.0.1
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BSC
BTSDEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINTERF
ACE
BTSDEVIP
*Port No.
Transmission
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
218
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the GTMU
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Index
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.236
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
IP Mask
255.255.255.0
Transmission
BTSDEVIP
BTS Inner IP
Switch
NO
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS
Communication
Type
LOGICIP
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS IP
88.200.8.236
Transmission
BTSIP
BSC IP
25.14.1.1
Transmission
BTSIP
BTS MultiIP
Switch
NO
Transmission
BTSESN
BTS Interface
Board Bar Code
1
21021127226T
A9025307
Transmission
BTSESN
OM Bear Board
BACKBOARD
BBU
interconnection
BTSTUNNEL
Source: GTMU
Destination:
UMPT
The tunnel is
used for
backplane
transmission
interconnection.
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Index
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination IP
Address
Device IP
address of the
BSC: 25.14.1.1
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Destination
Address Mask
255.255.255.25
5
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Route Type
OUTIF
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the GTMU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
219
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BTSIPRT
Interface Type
TUNNEL
Clock
BTSCLK
Clock Type
PEER_CLK
Clock
BTSCLK
Peer Mode
LTE
Transmission
IPRT
Subrack No.
Transmission
IPRT
Slot No.
14
Transmission
IPRT
Destination IP
address
88.200.8.236
Transmission
IPRT
Destination
address mask
255.255.255.25
5
Transmission
IPRT
Gateway
Transmission
IPRT
Forward route
address
25.14.0.1
Transmission
IPRT
Priority
HIGH
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Clock
UMTS
PEERCLK
Clock
PEERCLK
Peer Standard
LTE
RF
RRU
RF Unit
Working Mode
Configurat
ion Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
UMTS
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the WMPT
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINT
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
220
Domain
Configurat
ion Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
88.200.8.238
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Transmission
IPPATH
Transmission
OMCH
BBU
interconnection
TUNNEL
The tunnel
starts from the
WMPT to the
UMPT and the
direction is
uplink.
Transmission
IPRT
Reconfigure IP
routes.
Configure
tunnel routes to
the U2000,
RNC, and
UMPT board,
and remove the
routes to the
BSC and IP
clock server.
Local IP
Change it to an
address on the
LTE side.
Route Type: IF
Port Type:
TUNNEL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
221
Domain
Configurat
ion Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
IPRT
Destination IP
Configure a
route from the
RNC to the
NodeB.
Transmission
NODEBIP
NodeB
TransType
IPTRANS_IP
Transmission
NODEBIP
NodeB
IP_TRANS IP
address
88.200.8.238
Transmission
NODEBIP
NodeB
IP_TRANS IP
Mask
255.255.255.25
5
Transmission
NODEBIP
NodeB
IP_TRANS
Subrack No.
Transmission
NODEBIP
NodeB
IP_TRANS Slot
No.
14
Transmission
NODEBIP
Whether
Binding logical
port or not
NO
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
222
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
223
Table 4-40 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service
configurat
ion
BBU
One BBU
RF
typology
Transmiss
ion
scheme
IP over Ethernet
Clock
networkin
g
IP reference clock
In this scenario, the GBTS must be reconstructed into an eGBTS, and the data plan must be
filled out. The filling method is described in the following table.
Data plan filling for reconstruction from a GBTS to an eGBTS
1. Filling in the GlobalPlanning page
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
224
PlanningXLSVer
SRAN11.1
Description
BscSctpIdBase
5000
GSM parameter,
which is
mandatory
BtsSctpPortBase
8001
GSM parameter,
which is optional
BtsTrxPerSctp
Number of TRXs
supported by each
SCTP of a base
station Default value:
12
12
GSM parameter,
which is optional
BtsOMCHPeerIP
10.141.14.22
GSM parameter,
which is
mandatory
BtsOMCHPeerIPMa
sk
255.255.255.0
GSM parameter,
which is
mandatory
SRANBaselineRAT
This parameter
does not need to be
set for single-mode
base stations, and it
is optional for
MBTSs.
WORKMODE
Mandatory when
E1/T1 transmission
is used in GSM
ActBTSSoftwareVer
sion
GSM evolution,
mandatory
BSCNodeRedundan
cyBSCName
Mandatory in the
BSC node
redundancy
scenario
ActGTMUSoftwareV
ersion
GTMU SingleOM,
mandatory
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
225
Description
Examples
ConvertFlag
Conversion ID
Yes
BtsName
GBTS name
GBTS_XX
NextHop
GTMU Abandoned
YES
UMPTSlot
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition from an eGBTS to GL coMPT in different domains. The data in these tables can be the references for data
configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.3 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Globa
l
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
CnOperator
502
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
PEERCLK
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Port No.
Trans
missi
ETHPORT
Cabinet No./Subrack
Corresponding
to those of the
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
226
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
on
Trans
missi
on
ETHPORT
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
No./Slot No.
main control
board
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
LTE
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
UBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
RF
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
GL
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
A new added
UMPT provides
Transmission
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
227
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
No./Slot No.
transmission.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.12
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the UMPT
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
255.255.0.0
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
228
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to the cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of
the UMPT
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.12
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
IPRT
Route Index
Configure three
IP routes.
The functions
are as follows:
OMCH
TO SG-W
TO MME
Set the route
type to Next
Hop and
specify the IP
addresses as
planned.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.12
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
229
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
230
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
231
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-46 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
232
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
1T2R
BBU
One BBU
RF typology
Chain topology
Transmission scheme
Clock networking
Data plan filling involved in the transition from a separate-MPT UMTS only base
station to a co-MPT UMTS only base station
1. GlobalPlanning page: No filling is required.
2. SitePlanning page
Table 2.2 Fields to be filled in the SitePlanning page
Field
Description
Examples
ConvertFlag
Conversion ID
Yes
NodeBName
NodeB name
NodeB_XX
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.3 UMTS data configuration
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
CPRI-based
topology
UMTS
RRUCHAIN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
233
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
3 to slot 1.
RF
RRU
The working
mode of RRUs is
changed from
UMTS single
mode to GU dual
mode.
Baseband
BBP
Add a WBBPf to
slot 3 and change
the slot housing
the original
WBBPd to slot 0.
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment ID
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment Type
ULDL
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
UMTS UL
Demodulation Mode
ULDL
Baseband
BASEBANDE
QM
Baseband
Equipment Board
0,0,0;0,0,3
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
ADJNODE
Adjacent Node
ID
14410
GCELL
Three cells
working on the
900 MHz
frequency band
Radio
Values of Local
Cell ID are 0, 1,
and 2,
respectively.
Values of TRX
Group ID are
441, 442, and
443,
respectively.
Transmission
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
SCTPLNK
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
Application
ABISCP
234
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
type
Transmission
SCTPLNK
SCTP link ID
1441
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Signalling link
mode
SERVER
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First local IP
address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First destination
IP address
25.14.24.141
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Destination
SCTP port No.
1026
Transmission
IPPATH
Adjacent Node
ID
14410
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Interface Type
ABIS
Transmission
IPPATH
Is eGBTS
Yes
Transmission
IPPATH
IP path type
QoS
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP address
25.14.24.141
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
GSM
BRI
Add a UBRI to
slot 1.
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
GU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
235
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
25.14.24.141
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
25.14.0.1
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
457
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
The main
control board
provides
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
25.14.24.141
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
1026
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
58080
Transmission
GBTSPATH
Path ID
0
Configure an IP
path ID for the
eGBTS. (Note
that the IP path
ID cannot be
the same as that
of UMTS
before
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
236
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
transition.
Otherwise, the
original data
will be
overwritten.)
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
0
Note that the
CP Bear No.
cannot be the
same as that of
UMTS before
transition.
Otherwise, the
original data
will be
overwritten.)
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
25.14.24.141
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
25.14.1.1
Transmission
GBTSABISCP
Control Port ID
Transmission
GBTSABISCP
CP Bear No.
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
GSM
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
237
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Sector Name
sectors.
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
0:
0,60,0,R0B,RX
_MODE,;0,60,0
,R0A,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
1:
0,61,0,R0B,RX
_MODE,;0,61,0
,R0A,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
2:
0,62,0,R0B,RX
_MODE,;0,62S,
0,R0A,RXTX_
MODE,MASTE
R
Radio
GTRXGROUP
TRX Group ID
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
238
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
consistent with
those on the
BSC side.
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Local Cell ID
0, 1, and 2
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Sending Mode
SINGLESND
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Receiving
Mode
MAINDIVERS
ITY
Note that the
configuration of
transmit and
receive mode
must be
consistent with
the number of
sector
equipment
antennas.
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Working Mode
INDEPENDEN
T
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Sector
Equipment ID
0, 1, and 2
Global
APPLICATION
Application
Maintenance
Mode
INSTALL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
239
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
240
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-53 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
G[U*L] multimode
Service configuration
241
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
BBU
One BBU
RF typology
Transmission scheme
GSM E1 transmission,
UMTS transmission through
panel, IP over Ethernet
GSM E1 transmission
remains unchanged. UMTS
and LTE co-transmission
through IP over Ethernet
Clock networking
Data plan filling involved in the transition from a separate-MPT UMTS only base
station to a co-MPT UMTS only base station
1. GlobalPlanning page: No filling is required.
2. SitePlanning page
Table 2.2 Fields to be filled in the SitePlanning page
Field
Description
Examples
ConvertFlag
Conversion ID
Yes
NodeBName
NodeB name
NodeB_XX
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.3 GSM configuration
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Radio
GSM
GCELL
Freq. Band
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
242
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
frequency band.
Radio
TRXINFO
Configure two
TRXs in each
cell using the
main and
diversity RX
channels.
Radio
TRXBIND2PH
YBRD
CPRI-based
topology
BTSRXUCHAI
N
RF
BTSRXUBRD
RF
BTSRXUBP
MRRU/GRRU/
AIRU Sending
Receiving
Mode
DOUBLEDOU
BLE_ANTENN
A
RF
BTSRXUBP
Working
GSM_AND_LT
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
243
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Standard
Configur
ation
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Global
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
Global
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
Global
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
Global
CnOperator
Mobile Country
code
502
Global
CnOperator
Mobile network
code
04
Transmission
SCTPPEER
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
USERPLANEP
EER
Peer IP Address
171.23.36.1
APPLICATIO
N
Application
Maintenance Mode
Transmission
Global
(To MME)
(To S-GW)
INSTALL
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
LTE
eNodeBFuncti
on
eNodeB ID
380
CPRIbased
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
244
Domain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
cabinet
No./subrack
No./slot No. of the
three RRUs are as
follows:
0/60/0 - 0/62/0
Working mode:
GL
Baseband
BBP
GSM-0&UMTS1<E_FDD1<E_TDD-0
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
The main
control board
provides
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.7.15
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
245
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.7.15
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R8
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.7.15
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
IPRT
Route Index
Configure two
IP routes.
Destination IP
addresses:
171.23.36.1
125.120.120.1
The route type
is set to
NEXTHOP.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
246
Domain
Configurati
on Object
Transmission
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 3
through 5.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
3:
0,60,0,R0A,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,60,0,
R0B,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
4:
0,61,0,R0A,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,61,0,
R0B,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
247
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
5:
0,62,0,R0A,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,62,0,
R0B,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
248
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
249
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-60 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service
configurati
on
250
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
UMPT+UMPT
GSM and UMTS sharing the same BBU;
LTE using the other BBU
RF
typology
Transmissi
on scheme
Clock
networkin
g
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Globa
l
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
Globa
l
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
Globa
l
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
Globa
l
CnOperator
502
Globa
l
CnOperator
04
Clock
TIMESRC
Time Source
NTP
Clock
NTPCP
10.141.142.22
Clock
NTPCP
Synchronization Period
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
PEERCLK
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
FREQ
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
251
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Mode
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL_PRC
Clock
PEERCLK
Peer Standard
UMTS
Clock
PEERCLK
Equip
ment
EQUIPMENT
Maintenance Mode
INSTALL
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
MPT
LTE
MPT
Cabinet No.
MPT
MPT
Subrack No.
MPT
MPT
Slot No.
MPT
MPT
Board Type
LMPT
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet No.
Cabinet No.: 0
Cabinet Type
Type: BTS3900
Cabinet No.
Cabinet No.: 0
Subrack No.
Subrack 0:
BBU3900
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack Type
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
RRUCHAIN
252
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
RF
RFU
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Configure an RFU
on the new RRU
chain. The RFU
slot number must
be different from
that of the
configured RFU
for GU, and the
working mode of
the RFU must be
set to GSM_LTE.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RET
RET Type
SINGLE_RET
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Polar Type
DUAL
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Antenna Scenario
REGULAR
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Cabinet No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Subrack No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
3, 4, and 5
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Subunit No.
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Connect Port 1
Cabinet No.
Connect to the
following:
0\4\3 R0A- 0\4\3
R0B
0\4\4 R0A0\4\4R0B
0\4\5 R0A- 0\4\5
R0B
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
253
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.133.3.12
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
2913
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BACK_BOAR
D
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
TUNNEL
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.133.3.12
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
254
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
OMCH
Standby Status
MASETR
Transmission
OMCH
Local IP
160.133.3.12
Transmission
OMCH
Local Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
OMCH
Peer IP
10.141.142.22
Transmission
OMCH
Peer Mask
255.255.255.0
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/7
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
LOOPINT
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.133.3.12
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
BBU
interconnection
TUNNEL
The tunnel
starts from the
UMPT to the
GTMU and the
direction is
downlink.
Transmission
IPRT
Route Index
Configure the
IP routes for the
U2000, MME,
and S-GW. If
co-transmission
through
backplane
interconnection
is used, the
tunnel provides
routing.
BBU
interconnection
CTRLLNK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
255
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
No., and slot
No. being 0, 0,
and 7,
respectively.
Transmission
ETHPORT
Port No.
Transmission
ETHPORT
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
UMPT in
subrack 1.
Transmission
ETHPORT
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
0:
0,4,3,0,3,0;0,4,3
,1,3,0
1:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
256
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
0,4,4,0,3,0;0,4,4
,1,3,0
2:
0,4,5,0,3,0;0,4,5
,1,3,0
Radio
Cell
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
CPRI-based
topology
GSM
BTSRXUCHAI
N
Configure three
RRU chains on
optical ports 1,
3, and 5 on the
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
257
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
GTMU.
RF
BTSRXUBRD
Added one
MRRU to
position 0 of
each of the
newly added
three chains.
RF
BTSRXUBP
Working
Standard
GSM_AND_LT
E
Note that the
working mode
of the new RF
module must be
set to GL.
Radio
GCELL
Freq. Band
Radio
TRXINFO
Configure two
TRXs in each
cell using the
main and
diversity RX
channels.
Radio
TRXBIND2PH
YBRD
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
BBU
interconnection
UMTS
CTRLLNK
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
258
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
cabinet No.,
subrack No., and
slot No. being 0,
0, and 7,
respectively.
BBU
interconnection
TUNNEL
Add a tunnel to
the UMPT_L
board.
The tunnel
direction is uplink.
Transmission
IPRT
Configure IP
routes. Configure
a tunnel to the
UMPT_L board.
Transmission
DHCPSVRIP
DHCP Server IP
Address
Transmission
DHCPRELAY
SWITCH
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
OMCH AutoEstablishment
Switch
ENABLE
Transmission
DHCPSW
Vlanscan Switch
DISABLE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
259
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
260
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Table 4-67 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
GU+LT quadruple-mode
Service
configurati
on
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
261
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
configured
BBU
RF
typology
Transmissi
on scheme
Clock
networkin
g
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 BSC data configuration
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Clock
BSC
BTSCLK
CLKSYNCMODE
TIMESYN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
262
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Clock
UMTS
TASM
Clock
Synchronization
Mode
TIME
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Clock
LTE
GPS
Clock
GPS
Cabinet No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0/1/0
Clock
CnOperator
AUTO_SEARC
H
Clock
GPS
GPS
Clock
GPS
04
Clock
TASM
MANUAL
Clock
TASM
Clock
TASM
GPS
Clock
TASM
Clock Synchronization
Mode
TIME
Clock
TASM
Quality Level
QL-SSU-B
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
LTE
USCU
Cabinet No.
Equipment
USCU
Subrack No.
Equipment
USCU
Slot No.
Equipment
USCU
Board Type
LMPT
Baseband
BBP
Cabinet No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
263
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
BBP
Subrack No.
Baseband
BBP
Slot No.
Baseband
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
Baseband
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet No.
Cabinet Type
Cabinet Type:
BTS3900
Equipment
SUBRACK
Cabinet No.
Cabinet No.: 0
Subrack No.
Subrack 0:
BBU3900
Subrack Type
RRUCHAIN
RF
RFU
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RET
RET Type
SINGLE_RET
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Polar Type
DUAL
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Antenna Scenario
REGULAR
Antenna and
feeder
RET
Control Port
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No. of
the three new
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
264
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
RRUs
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Device No.
0, 1, and 2
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Subunit No.
Antenna and
feeder
RETSUBUNIT
Connect Port 1
Cabinet No.
Connected to
channels A and B
of the three RRUs
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
265
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
3:
0, 60, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 60, 0, 1, 3, 0;
0, 60, 0, 2, 3, 0;
0, 60, 0, 3, 3, 0
4:
0, 61, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 61, 0, 1, 3, 0;
0, 61, 0, 2, 3, 0;
0, 61, 0, 3, 3, 0
5:
0, 62, 0, 0, 3, 0;
0, 62, 0, 1, 3, 0;
0, 62, 0, 2, 3, 0;
0, 62, 0, 3, 3, 0
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
266
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
share equipment
0.
Radio
CellOp
Radio
CnOperatorTa
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
267
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
268
Table 4-73 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
LTE single-mode
Service
configurat
ion
BBU
One BBU
RF
typology
Transmiss
ion
scheme
IP over Ethernet
Clock
networkin
g
Data plan filling involved in the transition from a separate-MPT LTE only base station
to a co-MPT LTE only base station
Description
Examples
ConvertFlag
Conversion ID
Yes
eNodeBName
eNodeB name
eNodeB_XX
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
269
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
RF
LTE
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
GL
RRUCHAIN
Topo Type
LOADBALANCE
CPRI-based
topology
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
BSC
ADJNODE
Adjacent Node
ID
523
GCELL
Three cells
working on the
1800 MHz
frequency band
Radio
SCTPLNK
Application
type
ABISCP
Transmission
SCTPLNK
SCTP link ID
523
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Signalling link
mode
SERVER
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First local IP
address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First destination
IP address
25.14.7.10
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Destination
SCTP port No.
1024
Transmission
IPPATH
Adjacent Node
ID
523
Transmission
IPPATH
IP path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Interface Type
ABIS
Transmission
IPPATH
Is eGBTS
Yes
Transmission
IPPATH
IP path type
QoS
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
270
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP address
25.14.7.10
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
GSM
BRI
Add an UBRI
board to slot 1.
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
Change Topo
Type to LOAD
BALANCE for
the RRU chain
and add CPRI
ports to the
UBRIb board.
RF
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
GL
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
GSM
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
25.14.7.10
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
25.14.0.1
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
271
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
457
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
The main
control board
provides
transmission
ports.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
25.14.7.10
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
Port No.
1024
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
25.14.1.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
58080
Transmission
GBTSPATH
Path ID
1
Configure an IP
path ID for the
eGBTS. (Note
that the IP path
ID cannot be
the same as that
of UMTS
before
transition.
Otherwise, the
original data
will be
overwritten.)
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
1
Note that the
CP Bear No.
cannot be the
same as that of
UMTS before
transition.
Otherwise, the
original data
will be
overwritten.)
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
272
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
Corresponding
to those of the
main control
board
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
25.14.24.141
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
25.14.1.1
Transmission
GBTSABISCP
Control Port ID
Transmission
GBTSABISCP
CP Bear No.
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
GSM
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 0
through 2.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
3:
0,60,0,R0B,RX
_MODE,SLAV
E;0,60,0,R0A,R
XTX_MODE,
MASTER
4:
0,61,0,R0B,RX
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
273
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
_MODE,SLAV
E;0,61,0,R0A,R
XTX_MODE,
MASTER
5:
0,62,0,R0B,RX
_MODE,SLAV
E;0,62,0,R0A,R
XTX_MODE,
MASTER
Antenna and
feeder
GTRXGROUP
TRX Group ID
0, 1, and 2
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Local Cell ID
3, 4, and 5
Radio
GTRXGROUP
Sector
Equipment ID
3, 4, and 5
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
274
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
275
Figure 1.2 Transmission networking topology before and after mode transition
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
276
Table 4-80 lists the major differences before and after mode transition.
Table 2.1 Major differences before and after mode transition
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
Service configuration
GU CPRI MUX
Transmission scheme
GU co-transmission and
separate service bearers, IP
over Ethernet
Clock networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 2.2 LTE global data configuration
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Globa
l
LTE
CnOperator
CN Operator ID
Globa
l
CnOperator
CN Operator name
LTE
Globa
l
CnOperator
CN Operator type
CNOPERATOR
_PRIMARY
Globa
l
CnOperator
502
Globa
l
CnOperator
04
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
277
Dom
ain
Configura
tion
Object
Globa
l
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
APPLICATION
Application
Maintenance Mode
INSTALL
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
LTE
eNodeBFunctio
n
eNodeB ID
49122
Baseband
MDU
GSM-1&UMTS1<E_FDD1<E_TDD-0
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet No.
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet Type
VIRTUAL
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack No.
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack Type
PMU
Equipment
PMU
Cabinet No.
Equipment
PMU
Subrack No.
Baseband
PMU
Slot No.
Equipment
PMU
Manager Cabinet
No.
Equipment
PMU
Manager Subrack
No.
Equipment
PMU
Equipment
PMU
Address
Equipment
PMU
ETP
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet No.
10
Equipment
CABINET
Cabinet Type
BBC
Equipment
SUBRACK
Cabinet No.
10
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack No.
Equipment
SUBRACK
Subrack Type
TCU
Equipment
TCU
Cabinet No.
10
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
278
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Equipment
TCU
Subrack No.
Equipment
TCU
Slot No.
Equipment
TCU
Manager Cabinet
No.
Equipment
TCU
Manager Subrack
No.
Equipment
TCU
Equipment
TCU
Address
24
Equipment
BATTERY
Cabinet No.
Equipment
BATTERY
Subrack No.
Equipment
BATTERY
Slot No.
Equipment
BATTERY
Installation Type
OUTER
Equipment
BATTERY
Battery Type
VRLA_BAT
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Transmission
LTE
SCTPLNK
Link No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0\0\6
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Local IP
Address
160.70.11.91
Transmission
SCTPLNK
Local SCTP
2913
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
279
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Port No.
Transmission
SCTPLNK
First Peer IP
Address
125.120.120.1
Transmission
SCTPLNK
2910
Transmission
CPBEARER
CP Bear No.
Transmission
CPBEARER
Flag
MASTER
Transmission
CPBEARER
Bear Type
SCTP
Transmission
CPBEARER
Link No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path ID
Transmission
IPPATH
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0\0\6
Transmission
IPPATH
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
IPPATH
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
IPPATH
Port No.
Transmission
IPPATH
Path Type
ANY
Transmission
IPPATH
Local IP
160.70.11.91
Transmission
IPPATH
Peer IP
171.23.36.1
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface ID
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface CP
Bearer ID
Transmission
S1Interface
CN Operator ID
Transmission
S1Interface
MME Release
Release_R10
Transmission
S1Interface
S1 Interface Is
Blocked
FALSE
Transmission
DEVIP
Cabinet
No./Subrack
No./Slot No.
0\0\6
Transmission
DEVIP
Subboard Type
BASE_BOARD
Transmission
DEVIP
Port Type
ETH
Transmission
DEVIP
Port No.
Transmission
DEVIP
IP Address
160.70.11.91
Transmission
DEVIP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
280
Domain
Configurati
on Object
Transmission
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
IPRT
Route Index
Configure two
IP routes.
Destination IP
addresses:
125.120.120.1
171.23.36.1
The route type
is set to
NEXTHOP.
Transmission
VLANMAP
Next Hop IP
160.70.7.10
Transmission
VLANMAP
Mask
255.255.0.0
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN Mode
SINGLEVLAN
Transmission
VLANMAP
VLAN ID
446
Transmission
VLANMAP
Set VLAN
Priority
DISABLE
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Antenna and
feeder
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Add three
sectors.
Sector Name
Sector Antenna
Antenna and
feeder
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Three pieces of
sector
equipment are
added.
They
correspond to
sectors 63
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
281
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
through 65.
The following
sector antennas
are used:
63:
0,63,0,R0B,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,63,0,
R0A,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
64:
0,64,0,R0B,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,64,0,
R0A,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
65:
0,65,0,R0B,RX
TX_MODE,M
ASTER;0,65,0,
R0A,RXTX_M
ODE,MASTER
Radio
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
282
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
equipment 63
through 65.
The LMPT cannot be shared by LTE FDD and LTE TDD to form a co-MPT base station. If an LMPT is
used, replace the LMPT with the UMPT, and then perform mode transition. For the operation guide of
replacing the LMPT with the UMPT, see section "Replacing the Main Control Board When No SeGW Is
Deployed" or "Replacing the Main Control Board When an SeGW Is Deployed" in eRAN
Reconfiguration Guide.
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
LTE FDD
LTE (FDD+TDD)
Service
configuratio
n
BBU
RF
typology
RRU chain
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
283
Item
Before Transition
After Transition
Transmissio
n scheme
IP over Ethernet
Clock
networking
The following tables list the MOs involved in the mode transition in different domains. The
data in these tables can be the references for data configuration in summary tables.
Table 1.2 Common data configuration
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommend
ed Value
Clock
LTE
GPS Clock
Link
Cabinet No.
Subrack No.
Slot No.
AUTO_SEARCH
Clock Working
Mode
MANUAL(Manua
l)
CLKSYNCMODE
TIME
Selected Clock
Source
GPS
TASM
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
LTE
BBP
Cabinet No.
Subrack No.
Slot No.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
284
Domain
CPRI-based
topology
RF
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
RRUCHAIN
RRU
Parameter
Name
Recommend
ed Value
Board Type
LBBP
Work Mode
TDD
Administrative State
UNBLOCKED
Chain No.
Topo Type
CHAIN
Backup Mode
COLD
Access Type
LOCALPORT
Cabinet No.
Subrack No.
61
Slot No.
TRUNK
RRU Position
RRU type
LRRU
RRU Name
TDD_RRU1
Administrative State
UNBLOCKED
OFF
30
VSWR alarm
threshold(0.1)
20
RF Unit Working
Mode
TDL
Number of RX
channels
Number of TX
285
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommend
ed Value
channels
Frequency Min
Bandwidth(kHz)
5000
Enable
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommen
ded Value
Baseband
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
Sector Name
sector_1
Sector Antenna
0, 61, 0, R0A;
0, 61, 0, R0B
0, 61, 0, R0C;
0, 61, 0, R0D
SECTOREQM
Radio
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Cell
Sector
Equipment ID
Sector ID
Sector
Equipment
Antenna
0, 61, 0, R0A,
RXTX_MODE,
MASTER; 0,
61, 0, R0B,
RXTX_MODE,
MASTER; 0,
61, 0, R0C,
RXTX_MODE,
MASTER; 0,
61, 0, R0D,
RXTX_MODE,
MASTER
Local Cell ID
Cell Name
Csg indicator
BOOLEAN_FA
LSE
Uplink cyclic
prefix length
NORMAL_CP
Downlink
NORMAL_CP
286
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommen
ded Value
cyclic prefix
length
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Frequency band
40
Uplink
EARFCN
indication
NOT_CFG
Downlink
EARFCN
38900
Uplink
bandwidth
CELL_BW_N1
00
Downlink
bandwidth
CELL_BW_N1
00
Cell ID
Physical cell ID
CELL_ACTIV
E
CELL_UNBLO
CK
CELL_TDD
Subframe
assignment
SA1
Special
subframe
patterns
SSP5
Cell specific
offset(dB)
dB0
Frequency
offset(dB)
dB0
Root sequence
index
LOW_SPEED
Preamble
format
Customized
bandwidth
configure
indicator
NOT_CFG
287
Domain
Baseband
Radio
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Cell sector
equipment
CellOp
Parameter
Name
Recommen
ded Value
Emergency
Area Id
indicator
NOT_CFG
Ue max power
allowed
configure
indicator
NOT_CFG
BOOLEAN_FA
LSE
CPRI
Compression
NO_COMPRE
SSION
BOOLEAN_FA
LSE
Cell
transmission
and reception
mode
4T4R
Work mode
UL_DL
Cell Standby
Mode
ACTIVE
Intra Frequency
RAN Sharing
Indication
BOOLEAN_TR
UE
Local cell ID
Sector
equipment ID
Reference
signal
power(0.1dBm)
32767
Baseband
equipment ID
255
Local cell ID
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
288
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Name
Recommen
ded Value
R_OP
Local tracking
area ID
Cell reserved
for operator
Operator uplink
RB used
ratio(%)
16
Operator
downlink RB
used ratio(%)
16
MME configure
number
CELL_MME_C
FG_NUM_0
Operator Ue
Number
Ratio(%)
16
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
289
The LMPT cannot be shared by LTE FDD and LTE TDD to form a co-MPT base station. If an LMPT is
used, replace the LMPT with the UMPT, and then perform mode transition. For the operation guide of
replacing the LMPT with the UMPT, see section "Replacing the Main Control Board When No SeGW Is
Deployed" or "Replacing the Main Control Board When an SeGW Is Deployed" in eRAN
Reconfiguration Guide.
Before Transition
After Transition
Mode
LTE TDD
LTE (FDD+TDD)
Service
configuratio
n
BBU
RF
typology
RRU chain
Transmissio
n scheme
IP over Ethernet
Clock
networking
NOTE
The LTE TDD mode supports
GPS/RGPS, IEEE1588 V2 or
1PPS+TOD reference clock.
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Baseband
LTE
BBP
Cabinet No.
BBP
Subrack No.
BBP
Slot No.
BBP
Board Type
LBBP
BBP
Work Mode
FDD
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
290
Domain
Config
uratio
n
Object
MOC
CPRI-based
topology
RRUCHAIN
RF
RRU
Parameter
Recommend
ed Value
Add an RRU to
optical port 0 on
the newly added
baseband
processing board.
Cabinet No.
Slot No.
One RRU in
subrack 61 is
added to the new
RRU chain.
RRU
RRU type
LRRU
RRU
RF Unit Working
Mode
LO
RRU
Number of RX
channels
Actual number of
transmit and
receive antennas
used by RRUs.
For example, 2.
Subrack No.
Number of TX
channels
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
Baseband
LTE
SECTOR
Sector ID
SECTOR
Sector Antenna
0, 61, 0, R0A;
0, 61, 0, R0B
SECTOREQM
Sector
Equipment ID
Sector ID
SECTOREQM
Radio
Cell
Sector
Equipment
Antenna
0, 61, 0, R0A;
0, 61, 0, R0B
Add one FDD
LTE cell: cell 1.
The related key
parameters are
set as follows:
FrequencyBand
:7
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
291
Domain
Configurati
on Object
MOC
Parameter
Recommen
ded Value
DlEarfcn: 3000
DlBandwidth:
CELL_BW_N1
00
UlBandwidth:
CELL_BW_N1
00
FddTddInd:
CELL_FDD
Cell
transmission
and reception
mode: 2T2R
Work mode:
UL_DL
EUCELLSECT
OREQM
CellOp
Local cell ID
Sector
equipment ID
Corresponding
to the cell and
sector
equipment
Add for cell 1.
With the related
parameters set
as follows:
Local tracking
area ID: 1
Cell reserved
for operator:
CELL_NOT_R
ESERVED_FO
R_OP
CnOperatorTa
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Local
tracking area
ID: 1
CN Operator
ID: 0
Tracking area
code: 11
292
5.1 Policies
Because the live network is affected during mode transition of a multimode base station, you
are advised to make preparations and perform the operations that do not affect services in
advance, and perform the operations that affect services in parallel. This can shorten the
service interruption duration.
During mode transition, data configuration and hardware adjustment are key operations and
the services are interrupted during these operations. Services can be restored only when these
two operations are consistent because they are interdependent. For example, when a CPRI
link is moved to a new port on the BBU during the transition, data related to the CPRI link
must be adjusted accordingly. Services of a multimode base station can be restored only when
the port adjustment is consistent with data configured for the CPRI link.
During mode transition, adjusting hardware and activating data configuration interrupt
services. Therefore, you are advised to perform these two operations in parallel. This
minimizes the service interruption duration during mode transition.
1. Complete operations that do not affect services in advance, such as pre-installation of
equipment of the new mode. Perform operations that affect services in parallel if possible to
shorten the duration.
2. During mode transition, hardware adjustment is required and must be performed with data
configuration in some transition scenarios. Only in this way the services can be restored
normally. Such hardware adjustment can be adjustment of CPRI links or transmission links. In
this case, perform hardware adjustment and data configuration activation in parallel to shorten
the service interruption period.
3. Upgrade the original mode before mode transition.
4. Before mode transition, perform refarming on the original mode to allocate a new
frequency to the new mode if necessary. Refarming shall be completed before site
reconstruction. In addition, ensure that a sufficient buffer zone is reserved for site
reconstruction during refarming.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
293
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
294
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
295
Alarm
Remarks
Hardware
Service
Communication
Inter-system conflict
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
296
Alarm Type
Alarm
Remarks
The service KPIs need to be collected based on site requirements. The following table lists the
common KPIs to be checked.
Table 1.2 Common KPIs
KPI Check Item
Counter to Check
Traffic volume
Others
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
297
7 Preparing Data
Preparing Data
This section describes the procedure for preparing data during mode transition.
Step 2 For GBTSs, BBU interconnection links cannot be added using a summary data file. Instead,
you can run MML commands on the MBSC to add the interconnect links before data
synchronization. (The MML command is ADD BTSCTRLLNK.)
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
298
7 Preparing Data
----End
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
299
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Right-click the MBSC to which the GBTS belongs and choose Synchronize NE
Configuration Data.
Step 3 Synchronize the UMTS data to the U2000, right-click the NodeB and choose Synchronize
NE Configuration Data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
300
7 Preparing Data
Step 5 On the CME, choose Area Management > Current Area > Synchronize NEs to
synchronize data to the U2000.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
301
7 Preparing Data
Step 6 In the displayed Synchronize NE(s) dialog box, select the MBSC and base station to be
synchronized.
Step 7 In the created planned data area, choose Area Management > Planned Area > Create
Planned Area. In the displayed Create Planned Area dialog box, add the MBSC and base
station, and click OK.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
302
7 Preparing Data
----End
You are advised to save configuration data on each base station side by referring to Saving
Configuration Data on the Base Station Side Before Mode Transition after synchronization for data
configuration rollback. For details about how to perform data configuration rollback, see Rolling Back
Base Station Configurations.
If co-MPT reconstruction involves the GSM mode and the corresponding BSC works in
redundancy backup mode, convert data based on the data planning tables of the primarily
BSC and secondarily BSC.
Start the Converting co-MPT Reconstruction Data in the standalone CME to convert data for
Reconstructing Base Stations into Co-MPT Base Stations
Step 1 Choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Co-MPT Data Conversion from the
menu bar to start the reconstruction wizard.
Step 2 Perform the following operations as required.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
303
7 Preparing Data
Option
Description
Specify save paths for the prepared data planning file, base station
conversion component, and base station controller conversion component.
i.
Click Next.
Step 4 Set common parameters for site deployment and click Next.
Common parameters include the subnet mask, area, ESN, and hot patch version.
Step 5 The CME starts the reconstruction. When the reconstruction is successful, the CME generates
site deployment lists, base station configuration files, and an incremental script for the base
station controller. Then, click Finish.
You can directly deliver the generated files to NEs for them to take effect. You can continue to
modify data on the CME to adjust the reconstructed base stations, for example, to introduce
RATs and reconstruct the transmission. After the data is modified, use the function of
exporting auto-deployment data provided by the CME to export the site deployment lists and
base station configuration files. If base station controller data is modified, you also have to
export an incremental script for the base station controller.
For details about how to export auto-deployment data, see Exporting Auto-Deployment
Data Files (Standalone). Note that you need to select Reconstruct site when
selecting a specific site deployment scenario, and load the site deployment list exported
in 5.
For details about how to export an incremental script, see Exporting Incremental
Scripts (Standalone).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
304
7 Preparing Data
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
GBTS
Equipment
data
Adjusting RF Data
(GBTS)
Transmissi
on data
Adjusting GBTS
Transmission Data
Radio data
Adjusting GBTS
Radio Data
Equipment
data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Device Data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Transmission Data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Adjusting Co-MPT
Radio Data
305
7 Preparing Data
On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application >
Export Data > Export RF Adjustment Data (CME client mode) or CME
> GSM Application > Export Data > Export RF Adjustment Data
(U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to select NE
versions and base station types.
j.
Select the version of the base station controller managing base stations to be
reconfigured.
k.
l.
Click Next to start the wizard of exporting GBTS data for RF adjustment.
Step 2 Verify the selected base station controller version in the NE version drop-down list.
Step 3 Click Add. Three modes for selecting base stations are available. You can select one of them
based on site requirements. For details about the modes, see Object Selection Modes.
Step 4 Click Next and perform operations based on application scenarios.
Scenario
Operation
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
2. Specify save paths for both the prepared data file for RF adjustment
306
7 Preparing Data
Scenario
Operation
Select the version of the base station controller managing base stations to
be reconfigured.
m.
n.
Click Next to start the wizard of importing GBTS data for RF adjustment.
Step 2 Verify the selected base station controller version in the NE version drop-down list and select
the base station controller managing base stations whose RF data is to be reconfigured from
the NE drop-down list.
Step 3 Select the data file for RF adjustment to be imported.
Step 4 Click Next and select base stations whose RF data is to be reconfigured.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
307
7 Preparing Data
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
Step 6 Optional: If you need to export scripts to separate files based on GBTSs, select Export
scripts in separate files based on GBTSs, and perform the following operations:
NOTE:
If data in the current planned data area has been reconfigured, and you want to export scripts using
the Export scripts in separate files based on GBTSs option, you have to export the
scripts for reconfiguring the data first.
If you adjust RFs for co-group and co-coverage cells that do not belong to the same base station, you
cannot generate scripts in separate files by base station.
a.
o.
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
iii.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
p.
Optional: If you need to activate scripts immediately after the wizard is complete,
select Launch the script executor if the task is successful.
Step 7 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to set attributes.
Set attributes based on Table 1. To set FH Attributes and Channel Rule, you need to click
Advanced.
Table 1 Setting attributes
Attribute
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
308
7 Preparing Data
Description
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
NOTE:
FH Attributes
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
The CME
generates data based on the FH type in the data file for RF adjustment. If the
default on the CME.
FH type is not specified in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
selected
in the wizard.
preset start value and allocates them.
NOTE:
Channel Rule
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
When FH type is NO_FH, the configuration of FH in PGSM/EGSM frequency band does not
take effect.
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot Extension Cell, the
configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2
on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively, and allocates all the other timeslots in the
cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
309
7 Preparing Data
Description
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
310
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting base station bulk configuration data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
311
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned
data.If parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter
records are the same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed
operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View).
Import the modified summary data file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Import
Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to import data for batch configuration.
Step 2 Specify the RAT of NEs to be imported, determine whether to import base station controller
data (base station data must be selected), and click Next.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be reconfigured
together.
Step 3 Start a wizard based on scenarios.
If...
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
312
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to adjust RF data using the summary data file, see Importing and
Exporting Co-MPT BTS RF Adjustment Data (standalone function).
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for RF Adjustment
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Set parameters displayed in the dialog box and specify the base stations whose data you want
to export.
Specify the RATs of the base stations whose data you want to export.
Specify the versions of the base stations and base station controller whose data you
want to export.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select
base stations defined in the file by importing a file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
313
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 3 Click Next. Then, specify the export mode, summary data file, and export path.
Table 3 Setting an export mode
Export Mode
Operation
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Select the file you want to import.
Step 3 Click Next, select the base stations for which you want to import the file.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
314
7 Preparing Data
Step 4 Optional: To generate configuration scripts in the wizard, select Export scripts and perform
the following operations:
Select the mode of generating scripts.
a.
To save scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To save scripts of logical base stations in separate files by base station, select
One by one.
Scripts on the base station side (only base stations in SRAN10.1 and later support
splitting scripts by RRU chain/ring):
To generate RRU incremental scripts in different files by RRU chain/ring, select Split
scripts by RRU chain. The CME automatically generates common incremental
scripts and RRU chain/ring incremental scripts. For base stations whose RRU
chain/ring fails to be separated, the CME generates scripts that are not separated.
NOTE:
If the common incremental script of the base station depends on the incremental RRU chain/ring script
or if two incremental RRU chain/ring scripts are associated, scripts cannot be separated by RRU
chain/ring.
q.
r.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
iii.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
315
7 Preparing Data
Description
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
FH Attributes
NOTE:
The
generates
basedunder
on the
in the
datawizard
file for
RF adjustment.
the by
CME
The minimum
IDdata
available
theFH
NEtype
selected
in the
functions
as the startIfvalue
default
on the
CME. in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
FH type
is not
specified
selected
in the
the imported
wizard. data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
When
preset start value and allocates them.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
Channel Rule
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot
Extension Cell, the configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME
automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2 on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively,
and allocates all the other timeslots in the cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
316
7 Preparing Data
Description
of a TRX in sequence.
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Follow-up Procedure
If you select Split scripts by RRU chain in the wizard of importing RF adjustment data,
you need to activate common incremental scripts of a single base station during script
activation and then activate RRU chain/ring incremental scripts in sequence by task. The
CME does not allow you to activate multiple scripts of a base station simultaneously. After
activating a script, ensure that the script takes effect on the base station side and the
base station is connected before activating the next script.
317
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For the method of adjusting data of a GBTS using TDM transmission, perform the following
steps:
1. Export GBTS data. For details, see the exporting function in section
Importing and Exporting GBTS Data (Summary)
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export GBTS Summary Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM Application
> Export Data > Export GBTS Summary Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box
is displayed for you to select GBTSs.
Step 2 Select a base station controller version from the NE version drop-down list.
Step 3 Click Add. Three GBTS selection modes are available. Select a mode as required. For details
about the modes, see Object Selection Modes.
Step 4 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to specify a save path.
NOTE:
If manual timeslots are configured in selected GBTSs, a dialog box is displayed to ask whether to
continue and provide GBTSs for which manual timeslots are configured.
Click Yes. A dialog box is displayed for you to specify a save path.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
318
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
The CME provides the Export scripts in separate files based on GBTSs option for
you to export scripts. You can export scripts to separate files based on GBTSs and export shared
objects to a file.
If data in the current planned data area has been reconfigured, and you want to export scripts using
the Export scripts in separate files based on GBTSs option, you have to export the
scripts for reconfiguring the data first.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import GBTS Summary Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM Application
> Import Data > Import GBTS Summary Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box
is displayed for you to select a summary data file.
Step 2 In the NE version and NE drop-down lists, select the base station controller to which base
stations to be created belong and its version.
Step 3 Select the summary data file you want to import.
If redundant device objects exist after the data for creating base stations in the summary data
file and data in the template are combined, after Delete redundant RF equipment data is
selected, the CME automatically deletes the device objects and subobjects that have not been
referenced by the cell.
Step 4 Click Next and select base stations you want to create.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 5 Optional: If you need to export scripts to separate files based on GBTSs, select Export
scripts in separate files based on GBTSs, and perform the following operations:
a.
s.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Select Yes.
319
7 Preparing Data
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
ii.
iii.
Optional: If you need to activate scripts immediately after the wizard is complete,
select Launch the script executor if the task is successful.
t.
Step 6 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to set attributes.
Step 7 Set BTS ID, Cell ID, and TRX ID based on the planned data.
NOTE:
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
default on the CME.
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
preset start value and allocates them.
Step 8 (Optional) Click Advanced. The advanced settings dialog box is displayed.
On the FH Attributes tab page, set the FH type based on the planned data
and determine whether to use the FH for GSM bands differentiated by the
P-GSM band and E-GSM band
a.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
u.
On the Channel Rule tab page, set the channel allocation rule for cells.
v.
Click OK.
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
320
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Export Data > Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you want to
reconfigure in batches.
Step 2 Select the base station controller version, base station version, and related base station, and
click Next.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Then...
Select objects you want to export in the wizard directly 1. Select Custom MOC.
and enable the CME to export data based on the selected 2. Select objects you want to export and specify a save
objects.
path for the exported file.
NOTE:
This mode does not apply to GBTSs.
Export data based on the objects contained in a prepared 1. Select Bulk configuration template.
file.
2. In Bulk configuration data file, select the
prepared file and export configuration data from the
CME based on the MOs in this file.
3. In Export path, specify a save path for the file that
contains the exported data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
321
7 Preparing Data
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Import the Abis interface data that has been reconfigured in batches.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Import Data > Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the Abis data that has been
reconfigured in batches.
Step 2 Perform operations as required.
If you need to...
Then...
Select the file you want to import and click Next. The CME starts to import the
file.
1. Select the file you want to import and select Export script by wizard.
2. Click Next.
3. Set the script generation information.
NOTE:
a.
NOTE:
When multiple base stations share MOs at the bottom link layer, such as MOs ETHIP,
PPPLNK, and MPGRP, if the script generation mode is set to One by one, primary
information (information about the subrack and slot numbers of an interface board) about
these MOs cannot be modified if the related IP addresses are not changed. Otherwise, data
may conflict after being imported into the CME.
b.
c.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects,
you have to enter encryption passwords by performing the following operations:
NOTE:
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the script
on the local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
1.
Select Yes.
2.
322
7 Preparing Data
Then...
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
e.
f.
Step 1 On the main menu of the planned data area, choose CME > GSM Application >
Reparent IP GBTS within BSC (U2000 client mode) or GSM Application >
Reparent IP GBTS within BSC (CME client mode). A dialog box is displayed for
you to configure reparenting information.
Step 2 Clear Export File.
Step 3 Click Next. In the displayed dialog box, select the reparenting data planning file you want to
import.
NOTICE:
You are advised to import a reparenting data planning file that is edited in and exported from CMEs of
the same version.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the reparenting data planning file and displays the verification
result.
If the verification fails, the CME displays a dialog box showing the parameters whose
values are incorrectly configured in the file. You can click Retry to edit the file again.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
323
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
324
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
325
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned
data.If parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter
records are the same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed
operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View).
Import the modified summary data file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Import
Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to import data for batch configuration.
Step 2 Specify the RAT of NEs to be imported, determine whether to import base station controller
data (base station data must be selected), and click Next.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be reconfigured
together.
Step 3 Start a wizard based on scenarios.
If...
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
326
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to use the Abis batch adjustment data, see Importing and Exporting
Abis Batch Adjustment Data.
Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Export Data > Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you want to
reconfigure in batches.
Step 2 Select the base station controller version, base station version, and related base station, and
click Next.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
327
7 Preparing Data
Then...
Select objects you want to export in the wizard directly 1. Select Custom MOC.
and enable the CME to export data based on the selected 2. Select objects you want to export and specify a save
objects.
path for the exported file.
NOTE:
This mode does not apply to GBTSs.
Export data based on the objects contained in a prepared 1. Select Bulk configuration template.
file.
2. In Bulk configuration data file, select the
prepared file and export configuration data from the
CME based on the MOs in this file.
3. In Export path, specify a save path for the file that
contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Import the Abis interface data that has been reconfigured in batches.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Import Data > Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the Abis data that has been
reconfigured in batches.
Step 2 Perform operations as required.
If you need to...
Then...
Select the file you want to import and click Next. The CME starts to import the
file.
1. Select the file you want to import and select Export script by wizard.
2. Click Next.
3. Set the script generation information.
NOTE:
a.
NOTE:
When multiple base stations share MOs at the bottom link layer, such as MOs ETHIP,
PPPLNK, and MPGRP, if the script generation mode is set to One by one, primary
information (information about the subrack and slot numbers of an interface board) about
these MOs cannot be modified if the related IP addresses are not changed. Otherwise, data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
328
7 Preparing Data
Then...
may conflict after being imported into the CME.
b.
c.
d.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption
passwords are required when you loading projects.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you
have to enter encryption passwords by performing the following operations:
NOTE:
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the script
on the local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
1.
Select Yes.
2.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
e.
f.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
329
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export Radio Network Planning Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Export Data > Export Radio Network Planning Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to select NEs.
Step 2 Select the base station controller and version of the NE to which the cells whose neighboring
and external cell data you need to export belong.
You can click
Objects in Batches.
Step 3 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to select export options.
Step 4 Select one or more data types as required.
Select one or more external cell types in the External Cell Type area.
Set the neighboring cell data that you need to export in the Neighboring Relationship
Type area.
a.
w.
Click Add. Three cell selection modes are available. Select cells in any mode based
on site requirements. For details about the modes, see Object Selection Modes.
NOTE:
To configure two cells under different base station controllers as neighboring cells, you need to export
data of external cells and neighboring cells and add the corresponding external cells to the exported file.
Otherwise, the neighbor relationships fail to be configured.
Step 5 Click Next to specify a file format (TXT, XLS, or XLSM) and a save path.
XLS and XLSM files contain all the configuration objects. Each configuration object
corresponds to a sheet.
Sheet names must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data in the file
during the import.
The TXT file contains only the selected configuration objects. Each configuration object
corresponds to a TXT file.
The TXT file name must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data in the
file during the import.
If the data to be exported exceeds 65,535 rows, save the data as a TXT or an XLSM file.
Step 6 Click Next. The CME exports neighbor relationship and external cell data.
Step 7 When the export is successful, click Finish.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
330
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
After the file is exported, you can click the path link in the dialog box to navigate to the folder where the
exported file is located.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import Radio Network Planning Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Import Data > Import Radio Network Planning Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to select files.
Step 2 Select a base station controller version from the NE version drop-down list.
Step 3 Select the file to be imported in TXT, XLS, or XLSM format.
Step 4 Click Add File to add the modified radio network data planning file.
Step 5 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to select an import mode.
Step 6 Select the type of the data to be imported and an import mode as required. For details, see
Table 2.
Table 2 Description of import modes
Import Mode
Whether
the
Object
Data
Exists on
the CME
Whether
Data Result on the CME After File Import
the Object
Data
Exists in
the File
Append
Yes
Yes
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
No
Yes
For the external cell data, the CME adds the data in the
file.
NOTE:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
331
7 Preparing Data
Whether
the
Object
Data
Exists on
the CME
Whether
Data Result on the CME After File Import
the Object
Data
Exists in
the File
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
NOTE:
Neighbor
relationships
are No
updated on a cell
basis.
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Update
Delete
Step 7 Click Next. The CME starts to import and verify the data.
If...
Then...
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If the CME displays the error information link, click the link and reconfigure the
332
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
related data.
If the CME displays the error information description, locate the error manually
based on the description and reconfigure the related data.
NOTE:
When importing the planned radio data, the CME automatically shields the invalid parameters in the file
without affecting the import of the other data. For example, the CME automatically shields the neighbor
relationships that fail to be imported because the related cells do not exist.
For details about inter-BSC reparenting based on the TDM and IP, see Importing and
Exporting Radio Network Optimization Data.
Importing and Exporting Radio Network Optimization Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export *** (CME client mode) or CME > GSM Application > Export Data >
Export *** (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to select cells.
NOTE:
Export *** can be Export Cell Parameter Data, Export Cell Frequency Data, and
Export Neighboring Cell BA Data.
Then...
Export data of certain cells under 1. Choose Cell from the Selected by drop-down list.
an NE
2. Select a base station controller version from the NE version drop-down
list.
3. Click Add. Three modes for selecting cells are displayed.
Select a mode as required. For details about the modes, see Object
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
333
7 Preparing Data
Then...
Selection Modes.
NOTE:
When you choose Export Cell Frequency Data, to filter other frequencies than those used by the
TRXs and FH groups, select Remove redundant frequencies.
Step 3 (Optional and required when you choose Export Cell Parameter Data) Click Next. Select
parameters you want to export, and click
NOTE:
You can click Save To File in the lower part of the dialog box to save the selected objects as a
file. You can directly load the file if you need to export these objects again.
You can click Load From File in the lower part of the dialog box to load the exported file that
contains the selected parameters. In this way, you do not need to manually select parameters.
Step 4 Click Next, and perform related operations based on the type of the data and file to be
exported.
Data Type File
Type
Export Cell
Parameter
Data
Operations
The TXT file contains only the selected configuration objects. Each configuration
object corresponds to a TXT file.
The TXT file name must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data
in the file during the import.
If the data to be exported exceeds 65,535 rows, save the data as a TXT or an XLSM
file.
The TXT file contain all the configuration objects. Each configuration object
corresponds to a TXT file. If a configuration object is empty, no TXT file is
generated for it.
The TXT file name must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data
in the file during the import.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If the data to be exported exceeds 65,535 rows, save the data as a TXT or an XLSM
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
334
7 Preparing Data
Operations
file.
2. Specify a save path for the file to be exported.
Export Cell
Frequency
Data
XLS and XLSM files contain all the configuration objects. Each configuration
object corresponds to a sheet.
Sheet names must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data in the
file during the import.
The TXT file contain all the configuration objects. Each configuration object
corresponds to a TXT file. If a configuration object is empty, no TXT file is
generated for it.
The TXT file name must not be changed. Otherwise, the CME fails to process data
in the file during the import.
If the data to be exported exceeds 65,535 rows, save the data as a TXT or an XLSM
file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import *** (CME client mode) or CME > GSM Application > Import Data >
Import *** (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to select files.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
335
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
Import *** can be Import Cell Parameter Data, Import Cell Frequency Data, and
Import Neighboring Cell BA Data.
Step 2 Select a base station controller version from the NE version drop-down list.
NOTE:
If the file format of Import Cell Frequency Data is XLS or XLSM, no NE version needs to be
specified.
Step 5 Click Next, and perform related operations based on the type of the data to be imported.
Data Type
Operations
Import
Cell Parameter Data
Import
Cell Frequency Data
Import
1. Select either of the following modes as required:
Neighboring
Append: adds or modifies neighboring cell BA data. The CME overwrites
Cell BA Data
the existing neighboring cell BA data with the data in the imported file.
Update: updates neighboring cell BA data. The CME updates the existing
neighboring cell BA data based on the data in the imported file.
2. Click Next. The CME starts to import and verify the data.
Step 6 Perform related operations based on the verification result.
If...
Then...
If the CME displays the error information link, click the link and reconfigure the
related data.
If the CME displays the error information description, locate the error manually
based on the description and reconfigure the related data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
336
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
337
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the
implementation of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis
interface data of a single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing
and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the
implementation of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub
interface data of a single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing
and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
338
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned
data.If parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter
records are the same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed
operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View).
Import the modified summary data file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Import
Data > Import Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to import data for batch configuration.
Step 2 Specify the RAT of NEs to be imported, determine whether to import base station controller
data (base station data must be selected), and click Next.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be reconfigured
together.
Step 3 Start a wizard based on scenarios.
If...
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
339
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Before exporting data based on a customized summary data file, use the function of customizing a
summary data file to customize a summary data file for RAT introduction. For details about how to
customize a summary data file, see Manually Customizing a Summary Data File.
In RAT introduction scenarios, you need to customize application maintenance mode parameters,
including AT and APPMNTMODE, of each RAT to a summary data file. When setting parameter values,
you are advised to set APPMNTMODE of the RAT to be introduced to TESTING.
Export co-MPT base station data to the summary data file for introducing RATs.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
340
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export co-MPT base station data.
Step 2 Select a scenario, RAT to be introduced to the co-MPT base station (for example, select LTE
for a co-MPT (GU) base station to be expanded to a co-MPT (GUL) base station), controller
version, base station version, base station to which RATs are to be introduced, and sample
base station, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Export expansion data
NOTE:
If you need to select base stations in batches by using a file, click Export to obtain an Excel file, edit
the file, and click Load to import it.
Operation
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
341
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
After the export is complete, you can click the link in the dialog box to open the exported file.
Summary data file, see Editing a Summary Data File (Customization Tool-based).
Import the summary data file in which data about RATs to be introduced has been edited into the CME.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the summary data file for
introducing RATs.
Step 2 Click
Step 3 Click Next and select co-MPT base stations for which you want to expand RATs.
If...
Then...
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
NOTE:
To generate scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To generate scripts of logical base stations in different files by base station, select One by
one.
b.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption
passwords are required when you loading projects.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you
have to enter encryption passwords by performing the following operations:
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
342
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
NOTE:
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the script on the
local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
1.
Select Yes.
2.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption
password as required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Step 4 (Optional and required when the new RATs include GSM) Click Next to set import options.
Set the start ID, frequency hopping attributes, and channel rules based on planned data.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME starts the import.
If...
Then...
The import
succeeds
1. View the failure report, or double-click the error message in the error list to open the
summary data file and locate the cell where the error data exists.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After data is corrected, click Retry to import the summary data file again.
Follow-up Procedure
After introducing RATs to the base station, use the function of exporting auto-deployment
files to export the deployment list and data configuration file in the RAT introduction
scenario. For detailed operations, see Exporting Files Related to Base Station
Creation/RAT Introduction to Co-MPT Base Stations.
NOTE:
You can use either of the following methods to adjust other data after introducing RATs to a base station:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction, and deliver them to the
live network for them to take effect. Then synchronize the data to the planned data area, adjust other
data, and then export an incremental script.
Do not export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction. Instead, continue
adjusting other data, and then use the function of exporting the site deployment list and data
configuration files to combine and export data in the RAT introduction and adjustment scenarios.
343
7 Preparing Data
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment
data
Adjusting
Separate-MPT
Device Data
Adjusting
Separate-MPT
Transmission Data
CoMPT
Radio data
Adjusting
Separate-MPT
Radio Data
Equipment
data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Device Data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Transmission Data
Radio data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Radio Data
The following table list the configuration method when UMTS works as the new mode.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
344
7 Preparing Data
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
Configuring
Separate-MPT Data
CoMPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
7.5.2.1 Separate-MPT
When the original mode is UMTS, you need to use the summary data file for batch
configuration (UMTS application) on the CME. If only the RF-related equipment data (RXU
board/TRX/cell capacity) needs to be adjusted, you can adjust RF data using the summary
data file.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details about how to use the summary data file for batch configuration, see Importing and
Exporting NodeB Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting NodeB Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose UMTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or
CME > UMTS Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk
Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to
export the data you want to reconfigure in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
345
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 In the Scenario drop-down list, select NodeB Bulk Configuration or Co-MPT BTS Bulk
Configuration based on the NodeB configuration.
Step 3 Select NodeBs whose data you want to reconfigure and click Next.
Step 4 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 6 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the exported summary data file and modify the file as planned.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
346
7 Preparing Data
You are advised to convert the summary data file to an MOC-integration view and edit the data. For
detailed operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View).
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to adjust RF data using the summary data file, see Importing and
Exporting NodeB RF Adjustment Data (standalone function).
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for RF Adjustment
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Set parameters displayed in the dialog box and specify the base stations whose data you want
to export.
Specify the RATs of the base stations whose data you want to export.
Specify the versions of the base stations and base station controller whose data you want
to export.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
347
7 Preparing Data
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 3 Click Next. Then, specify the export mode, summary data file, and export path.
Table 3 Setting an export mode
Export Mode
Operation
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Select the file you want to import.
Step 3 Click Next, select the base stations for which you want to import the file.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
348
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 4 Optional: To generate configuration scripts in the wizard, select Export scripts and perform
the following operations:
Select the mode of generating scripts.
a.
To save scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To save scripts of logical base stations in separate files by base station, select
One by one.
Scripts on the base station side (only base stations in SRAN10.1 and later support
splitting scripts by RRU chain/ring):
To generate RRU incremental scripts in different files by RRU chain/ring, select Split
scripts by RRU chain. The CME automatically generates common incremental
scripts and RRU chain/ring incremental scripts. For base stations whose RRU
chain/ring fails to be separated, the CME generates scripts that are not separated.
NOTE:
If the common incremental script of the base station depends on the incremental RRU chain/ring script
or if two incremental RRU chain/ring scripts are associated, scripts cannot be separated by RRU
chain/ring.
x.
y.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
349
7 Preparing Data
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
NOTE:
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
default on the CME.
FH Attributes
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
preset start value and allocates them.
The CME generates data based on the FH type in the data file for RF adjustment. If the
FH type is not specified in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
selected in the wizard.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
Channel Rule
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot
Extension Cell, the configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME
automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2 on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively,
and allocates all the other timeslots in the cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
350
7 Preparing Data
Description
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Follow-up Procedure
If you select Split scripts by RRU chain in the wizard of importing RF adjustment data,
you need to activate common incremental scripts of a single base station during script
activation and then activate RRU chain/ring incremental scripts in sequence by task. The
CME does not allow you to activate multiple scripts of a base station simultaneously. After
activating a script, ensure that the script takes effect on the base station side and the
base station is connected before activating the next script.
7.5.2.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is UMTS, you need to use the summary data file for batch
configuration (SRAN application) on the CME. If only the RF-related equipment data (RXU
board/TRX/cell capacity) needs to be adjusted, you can adjust RF data using the summary
data file.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
351
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details about how to use the summary data file for batch configuration (SRAN
application), see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting base station bulk configuration data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
352
7 Preparing Data
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
b.
c.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration
data from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
d.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
353
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to adjust RF data using the summary data file, see Importing and
Exporting Co-MPT BTS RF Adjustment Data (standalone function).
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for RF Adjustment
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Set parameters displayed in the dialog box and specify the base stations whose data you want
to export.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
354
7 Preparing Data
Specify the RATs of the base stations whose data you want to export.
Specify the versions of the base stations and base station controller whose data you want
to export.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 3 Click Next. Then, specify the export mode, summary data file, and export path.
Table 3 Setting an export mode
Export Mode
Operation
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Select the file you want to import.
Step 3 Click Next, select the base stations for which you want to import the file.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
355
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 4 Optional: To generate configuration scripts in the wizard, select Export scripts and perform
the following operations:
Select the mode of generating scripts.
a.
To save scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To save scripts of logical base stations in separate files by base station, select
One by one.
Scripts on the base station side (only base stations in SRAN10.1 and later support
splitting scripts by RRU chain/ring):
To generate RRU incremental scripts in different files by RRU chain/ring, select Split
scripts by RRU chain. The CME automatically generates common incremental
scripts and RRU chain/ring incremental scripts. For base stations whose RRU
chain/ring fails to be separated, the CME generates scripts that are not separated.
NOTE:
If the common incremental script of the base station depends on the incremental RRU chain/ring script
or if two incremental RRU chain/ring scripts are associated, scripts cannot be separated by RRU
chain/ring.
z.
aa.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
iii.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
356
7 Preparing Data
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
NOTE:
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
default on the CME.
FH Attributes
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
preset start value and allocates them.
The CME generates data based on the FH type in the data file for RF adjustment. If the
FH type is not specified in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
selected in the wizard.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
Channel Rule
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot
Extension Cell, the configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME
automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2 on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively,
and allocates all the other timeslots in the cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
357
7 Preparing Data
Description
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Follow-up Procedure
If you select Split scripts by RRU chain in the wizard of importing RF adjustment data,
you need to activate common incremental scripts of a single base station during script
activation and then activate RRU chain/ring incremental scripts in sequence by task. The
CME does not allow you to activate multiple scripts of a base station simultaneously. After
activating a script, ensure that the script takes effect on the base station side and the
base station is connected before activating the next script.
7.5.3.1 Separate-MPT
In separate-MPT scenarios where the original mode is UMTS, if only the base station data
needs to be adjusted, use the summary data file for batch configuration (GSM application) on
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
358
7 Preparing Data
the CME to configure transmission data. If the data of the base station and controller needs to
be adjusted together, use the Iub batch adjustment data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details about how to use the summary data file for batch configuration (UMTS
application), see Importing and Exporting NodeB Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting base station bulk configuration data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
359
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
360
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to use the Iub batch configuration data, see
Exporting Iub Batch Configuration Data
Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose UMTS Application > Export
Data > Export Iub Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > UMTS
Application > Export Data > Export Iub Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
361
7 Preparing Data
mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export Iub bulk configuration data, as
shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting Iub bulk configuration data
Step 2 In the Scenario drop-down list, select NodeB Bulk Configuration or Co-MPT BTS Bulk
Configuration based on the NodeB configuration.
Step 3 Select NEs whose data is to be reconfigured and the NE versions.
The CME can export Iub data about both the base station controller and base stations and can
also export Iub data only about the base station controller.
If you need to...
Then...
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export
to export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
362
7 Preparing Data
Then...
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export
to obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
When selecting base station controllers in the NE list, you can select base station controllers and
then click Export to export the selected base station controllers as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base station controllers by importing a file, you can
click Export to obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Then...
NOTE:
363
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
later versions and you have to export base station data between products) Select
Other UMTS controller version and select a version.
The version must be the same as the SPC version under the same R version of the
base station controller selected in 3.
3. Select objects you want to export and specify a save path for the exported file.
NOTE:
By default, objects related to the Iub interface have been added. You can adjust the objects as
required.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 6 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose UMTS Application > Import
Data > Import Iub Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > UMTS
Application > Import Data > Import Iub Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client
mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import Iub batch reconfiguration data.
Step 2 Select a file to be imported and set whether to generate configuration scripts through a wizard.
If...
Then...
Configuration
scripts do not
need to be
generated
Configuration
scripts need to
be generated
Select Export script by wizard and click Next. Then, set the sequence for generating scripts
as required.
1. Select Batch or One by one to generate all logical base station scripts in one script file or
generate scripts by base station, respectively.
NOTE:
When multiple NodeBs share MOs at the bottom link layer, such as MOs ETHIP, PPPLNK, and MPGRP, if
the script generation mode is set to One by one, primary information (information about the subrack and
slot numbers of an interface board) about these MOs cannot be modified if the related IP addresses are not
changed. Otherwise, data may conflict after being imported into the CME.
2. (Optional) If One by one is selected, click Up or Down to adjust the sequence for running
base station scripts.
3. Specify a save path for the script file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
364
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
4. (Optional) To enable the CME to automatically start the script executor after a script is
generated successfully in the wizard, select Launch the script executor if the task is
successful.
5. (Optional) Set an encryption mode for exported scripts.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords are
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have to
1.
Select Yes.
2.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Then...
Select Overwrite the Iub data (Do not inherit the MOCs
those do not exist in the summary file).
365
If...
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
If the CME detects that the parameter values of a shared object in the imported summary data file conflict, it
displays the conflict information in the following scenarios:
If a parameter value in the summary data file conflicts with an existing value in the planned data area, the
CME displays the conflict information and the conflict locating information.
If multiple parameter values conflict in the summary data file (for example, the parameter values of the
same object are the same under different base stations), the CME displays only conflict information.
If a parameter has the preceding two types of conflicts, the CME provides locating information about
only one data conflict, and displays other conflict information. You can check whether to modify the
configuration data based on the displayed information.
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
7.5.3.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is UMTS, you need to use the summary data file for batch
configuration (SRAN application) on the CME to configure transmission data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 4 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application
> Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or
CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export Data > Export Base Station
Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to
configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
366
7 Preparing Data
Step 5 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 6 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
367
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 7 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 8 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
368
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
7.5.4.1 Separate-MPT
When the original mode is UMTS in separate-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary
data file for batch configuration (SRAN application) on the CME to configure radio data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting NodeB Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Export Data > Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
369
7 Preparing Data
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you want to
reconfigure in batches.
Step 2 Select the base station controller version, base station version, and related base station, and
click Next.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Then...
Select objects you want to export in the wizard directly 1. Select Custom MOC.
and enable the CME to export data based on the selected 2. Select objects you want to export and specify a save
objects.
path for the exported file.
NOTE:
This mode does not apply to GBTSs.
Export data based on the objects contained in a prepared 1. Select Bulk configuration template.
file.
2. In Bulk configuration data file, select the
prepared file and export configuration data from the
CME based on the MOs in this file.
3. In Export path, specify a save path for the file that
contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Import the Abis interface data that has been reconfigured in batches.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Import Data > Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the Abis data that has been
reconfigured in batches.
Step 2 Perform operations as required.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
370
7 Preparing Data
Then...
Select the file you want to import and click Next. The CME starts to import the
file.
1. Select the file you want to import and select Export script by wizard.
2. Click Next.
3. Set the script generation information.
NOTE:
a.
NOTE:
When multiple base stations share MOs at the bottom link layer, such as MOs ETHIP,
PPPLNK, and MPGRP, if the script generation mode is set to One by one, primary
information (information about the subrack and slot numbers of an interface board) about
these MOs cannot be modified if the related IP addresses are not changed. Otherwise, data
may conflict after being imported into the CME.
b.
c.
d.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects,
1.
Select Yes.
2.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
e.
f.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
371
7 Preparing Data
7.5.4.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is UMTS in co-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data
file for batch configuration (SRAN application) on the CME to configure radio data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
372
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
373
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
374
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
Configuring
Separate-MPT Data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
375
7 Preparing Data
Scena
rio
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
CoMPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
7.5.5.2 Separate-MPT
When the new mode is UMTS in separate-MPT scenarios, deploy a new site using the
summary data file on the CME.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
1
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose CME > SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > MBTS RAT Priority Settings (U2000 client mode) or SRAN Application >
MBTS Application > MBTS RAT Priority Settings (CME client mode). A dialog box is
displayed for you to set priorities of the RATs that comprise a multimode base station.
If the current primary and secondary RATs are inconsistent with the planned ones,
perform 2 through 3.
If the current primary and secondary RATs are consistent with the planned ones, perform
3.
Step 2 Change the primary and secondary RATs according to the separate-MPT base station type.
The selected RAT is the primary RAT, and the other is the secondary RAT.
LTE_TDD indicates only the LTE TDD base stations that are supported since SRAN11.0, and
no LTE FDD cells can be added for such base stations.
Step 3 Click OK. A dialog box is displayed, indicating that the settings are successful.
Step 4 Click OK.
Open the summary data file in the basic scenario by using the function of customizing a summary
data file.
a.
On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (CME client
mode) or CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to open the summary data file.
b.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
376
7 Preparing Data
Scenario Basic Summary Template is the minimum set of configuration parameters for
base station creation. After you select information required for creating base stations, such as the
link mode, telecom operator sharing mode, and security information on the customization wizard,
the CME automatically adds related parameters to the summary data file according to your selection.
You can use the customization wizard to combine base station creation scenarios, which reduces
redundant parameters generated in the summary data file.
Other default summary data files are classified by scenario and contain all parameters in the related
scenarios. Therefore, the following problems may occur:
A summary data file fails to be verified due to data collision when the
customization wizard is used.
You can learn the introduction to scenarios by checking the information
displayed on the GUI of the summary data file.
c.
After the configuration is complete, click OK. The main window for customizing a summary data
file is displayed, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Window for customizing a summary data file
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
377
7 Preparing Data
Tab page, which displays a set of NE configuration parameters. This area can be customized.
Table, which lists the mappings between the parameter groups and parameters in a summary data file
and the NE configuration objects and parameters, respectively.
NE configuration objects and parameters are not editable. Parameter groups and parameters in a
summary data file can be customized.
: indicates a modified record.
: indicates an added record. Such tags will not be displayed next time after you save the summary
data file.
NOTE:
When the values of NE MOC and NE Attribute are empty in a record, the parameter is a new one in the
summary data file and there is no mapping between the parameter and NE configuration objects.
This parameter is referenced by other configuration parameters. If this parameter is not referenced, the parameter
value does not take effect.
If multiple NE configuration parameters are in the same summary parameter group and share the same name, they
are combined into a column in the generated summary data file.
Editable records are highlighted in white; Records that are not editable are highlighted in
can be deleted but cannot be modified are highlighted in
2.
; Records that
Start the wizard for customizing a summary data file, and customize basic and transport parameters
in a summary data file. Figure 2 shows the operation example.
NOTE:
The parameter specifications defined in the basic base station creation wizard must be lower than those
provided by NEs. If the planned data exceeds the defined parameter specifications, you can manually
customize data after completing operations by following the wizard.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
378
7 Preparing Data
Tip1
Tip2
3.
Configure data based on the planned data in each step on the wizard.
(Optional and required when the summary data file customized on the wizard does not contain all
parameters to be configured) Manually customize parameters to be configured in the summary data
file.
If you need
to...
Then...
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
379
7 Preparing Data
The parameter marked in red is the primary key parameter under the configuration
object. When adding a parameter, you must add the primary key parameter under the
configuration object to which the parameter belongs.
Only one configuration object can be customized on the XXXX Pattern orXXXX List
tab page.
Click
to verify validity of the edited summary data file. Then, modify the file based on the
verification result.
If the verification fails, you can double-click the error message. Then, the CME automatically locates
the error. You have to rectify the error until the verification succeeds.
NOTE:
If an alarm is generated indicating that the branch parameter does not exist in the verification result, you
need to determine whether to customize the parameter to the summary data file based on the planned
data. The alarm does not affect the subsequent operation of saving data.
380
2.
7 Preparing Data
Open the summary data file in the basic scenario by using the function of customizing a summary
data file.
a.
On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (CME client
mode) or CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to open the summary data file.
b.
Scenario Basic Summary Template is the minimum set of configuration parameters for
base station creation. After you select information required for creating base stations, such as the
link mode, telecom operator sharing mode, and security information on the customization wizard,
the CME automatically adds related parameters to the summary data file according to your selection.
You can use the customization wizard to combine base station creation scenarios, which reduces
redundant parameters generated in the summary data file.
Other default summary data files are classified by scenario and contain all parameters in the related
scenarios. Therefore, the following problems may occur:
A summary data file fails to be verified due to data collision when the
customization wizard is used.
You can learn the introduction to scenarios by checking the information
displayed on the GUI of the summary data file.
c.
After the configuration is complete, click OK. The main window for customizing a summary data
file is displayed, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
381
7 Preparing Data
Tab page, which displays a set of NE configuration parameters. This area can be customized.
Table, which lists the mappings between the parameter groups and parameters in a summary data file
and the NE configuration objects and parameters, respectively.
NE configuration objects and parameters are not editable. Parameter groups and parameters in a
summary data file can be customized.
: indicates a modified record.
: indicates an added record. Such tags will not be displayed next time after you save the summary
data file.
NOTE:
When the values of NE MOC and NE Attribute are empty in a record, the parameter is a new one in the
summary data file and there is no mapping between the parameter and NE configuration objects.
This parameter is referenced by other configuration parameters. If this parameter is not referenced, the parameter
value does not take effect.
If multiple NE configuration parameters are in the same summary parameter group and share the same name, they
are combined into a column in the generated summary data file.
Editable records are highlighted in white; Records that are not editable are highlighted in
can be deleted but cannot be modified are highlighted in
2.
; Records that
Start the wizard for customizing a summary data file, and customize basic, transport, and security
data in the file.
NOTE:
The parameter specifications defined in the basic base station creation wizard must be lower than those
provided by NEs. If the planned data exceeds the defined parameter specifications, you can manually
customize data after completing operations by following the wizard.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
382
7 Preparing Data
Use the customization wizard to customize basic and transport data. Figure 2 shows an
operation example.
Figure 2 Operations on the wizard
Tip1
Tip2
b.
Configure data based on the planned data in each step on the wizard.
Use the security wizard to customize security-related data. Figure 3 shows an operation
example.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
383
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When configuring data in the wizard, observe the following:
Tip 1
Steps in a wizard to be emphasized on are marked with Tip in the preceding figure. You can view
related descriptions based on site requirements.
When multi-level CA certificates in the certificate chain provided by you are stored separately,
configure multiple CA records.
When you provide a certificate chain file, configure a certificate chain record.
Tip 2
Configure security gateway information records based on collected IKE and IPsec algorithms and
combination status of these algorithms provided by you. For example, two IKE algorithms, two IPsec
algorithms, and only three IKE and IPsec algorithm combination methods are provided. You need to
configure only three security gateway information records.
Tip 3
Sequence Number of IPsec tunnel of IPsec tunnels configured for the same port cannot be
duplicate.
Tip 4
3.
After the operations in the wizard are complete, a customization report is generated. The report
displays user-specified information, automatically added MOs and planned parameter values
(excluding default values), and information that needs to be set manually.
(Optional and required when the summary data file customized on the wizard does not contain all
parameters to be configured) Manually customize parameters to be configured in the summary data
file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
384
7 Preparing Data
If you need
to...
Then...
The parameter marked in red is the primary key parameter under the configuration
object. When adding a parameter, you must add the primary key parameter under the
configuration object to which the parameter belongs.
Only one configuration object can be customized on the XXXX Pattern orXXXX List
tab page.
Click
to verify validity of the edited summary data file. Then, modify the file based on the
verification result.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
385
7 Preparing Data
If the verification fails, you can double-click the error message. Then, the CME automatically locates
the error. You have to rectify the error until the verification succeeds.
NOTE:
If an alarm is generated indicating that the branch parameter does not exist in the
verification result, you need to determine whether to customize the parameter to the
summary data file based on the planned data. The alarm does not affect the
subsequent operation of saving data.
In Microsoft Office Excel 2003, the macro function must be enabled and the macro
security level must be set to Medium.
In Microsoft Office Excel 2007 and Excel 2010, the macro function must be enabled.
For detailed operations, see Setting the Macro Security Level in an Excel File.
Edit global data, which is the same for all base stations, on the Common
Data sheet. Such parameters include the telecom operator information and
OSS IP address.
bb.
Edit basic information, which is different for all base stations, on the Base Station
Transport Data sheet or the MO list sheet (XXXX List). For example:
Edit the basic base station information including the base station name and type
on the Base Station Transport Data sheet.
Edit base station functions and locations on the corresponding MO list sheet
(XXXX List).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
The configuration data of devices uses the values in the base station
template. Therefore, you need to set the name of the prepared base station
template on the Base Station Transport Data sheet.
386
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
Only the default template name is displayed in the drop-down list for selecting a template in the
summary data file. Therefore, before selecting a user-defined template, you have to click
to add the user-defined template name to the drop-down
list.
Information about the user-defined template must be consistent with that about the existing template on
the CME.
cc.
Edit clock data and time data on the Common Data sheet.
Edit the data planned for each base station, such as the IP address, subnet, and port
number, on the Base Station Transport Data sheet.
b.
Edit the parameters for the MOs corresponding to each interface on the corresponding MO sheets
(XXXX List or XXXX Pattern). For example, device IP addresses and SCTP links are MOs.
If the value of a parameter on the XXXX Pattern sheet varies among base stations, you
can click
and select the parameter that needs to be referenced.
Microsoft Excel automatically generates the reference path for the parameter in the
summary data file. Figure 1 provides an example for using the reference function.
Advantage of the reference function: The value of one parameter can be referenced on
multiple XXXX Pattern sheets. Therefore, after a reference relationship is set, you only
need to change the referenced parameter value and do not need to modify the
parameters on the XXXX Pattern sheets even if the referenced parameter value
changes.
Restriction of the reference function:
If a branch parameter has been set to be referenced by another parameters, the summary
data file does not enable or disable the parameters controlled by the branch parameter.
The CME will still check accuracy of all the parameters during the import.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
387
7 Preparing Data
Under the Device IP Address object in the preceding figure, to retain the parameter
value of IP Address on port 0 in slot 7 of subrack 0 in cabinet 0 the same as the
parameter value of IP 1 under the NodeB IP address object on the Base Station
Transport Data sheet, you have to enter the path of the referenced parameter Base
Station Transport Data\NodeB IP address\IP 1 as the parameter value of IP Address
on port 0 in slot 7 of subrack 0 in cabinet 0. The CME assigns a parameter value based
on the reference path.
During IP route configuration, if the value obtained after a logic AND operation is
performed on the IP address and subnet mask is not equal to the IP address, you need to
use the macro function
address that meets the rule.
The IP address verification rule is the same as the NE configuration rule. That is, after a
logical AND operation is performed on the IP address and subnet mask, the obtained
value is equal to the IP address.
For detailed operations related to macro functions, see Figure 2.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
388
7 Preparing Data
Figure 2 Settings
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
389
7 Preparing Data
Specify the sheet, parameter group, and parameter name that correspond to
the IP addresses and subnet masks to be calculated.
Specify locations in the summary data file for the calculated IP addresses and
subnet masks.
To add a row next to the parameter specified in step 1 and show the
calculated IP addresses and subnet masks in the added row, perform the
following operations:
Click Add and add a conversion rule. You can repeat steps 1 and 2 to add
multiple conversion rules.
Non-32-bit subnet mask: After you enter IP addresses and subnet masks, a
logic AND operation is performed on them. The obtained network codes
replace the IP addresses, and the subnet masks are replaced with
255.255.255.255.
32-bit subnet mask: The IP addresses remain the same. The entered subnet
masks are replaced with 255.255.255.255.
Click OK. Excel starts the calculation based on the preset information.
Step 7 Configure automatic deployment data about the base stations to be created.
Click the Auto Deployment sheet and set the value of each parameter based on the planned
data.
Step 8 Close the modified summary data file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
390
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose UMTS Application > Import
Data > Import Base Station Summary Data (CME client mode) or CME > UMTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Summary Data (U2000 client
mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to create base stations using a summary data
file.
Step 2 Click
If redundant device objects exist after the data for creating base stations in the summary data
file and data in the template are combined, after Delete redundant RF equipment data is
selected, the CME automatically deletes the device objects and subobjects that have not been
referenced by the cell.
Step 3 Click Next and select base stations you want to create.
You are advised not to select sample base stations.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import
fails.
Step 5 (Optional and required when the CME generates scripts during the import of the summary
data file) Select Export Scripts and specify a save path for the scripts.
If One by one is selected, the generated scripts are divided by NodeB. One file is
generated for each NodeB, and shared object data is generated in an independent file.
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
391
7 Preparing Data
If...
Then...
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
Step 1 Obtain the radio data planning file 3G Radio Network Planning Data
Template.xls from U2000 client installation path\client\client\Data\BSC
version\Model\local\language\Template.
Step 2 Open the file and reconfigure the data as planned.
You are not allowed to modify the parameters marked in gray in the file.
Step 3 Import the radio data planning file.
The CME imports the file by NE. For example, the CME contains data about 10 NEs and data
only about one of the NEs is contained in the file to be imported. After the file is imported, the
CME reconfigures data only about the specified NE in the file. For data about the other NEs,
the CME reconfigures only the interlocked data.
NOTE:
a.
When you modify a parameter that supports automatic synchronization in UCELL, the CME
automatically updates the parameters (for example, external cell information) that are associated
with this parameter on other RNCs in the planned data area. For details about associated parameters,
see the Associated_Parameter.xls file in U2000 client installation
path\client\client\Data\Common\AssociatedParameter\language.
You can use the inter-U2000 neighboring cell management function to ensure
that the cell associated parameters are consistent in different U2000 systems. For
detailed operations, see Synchronizing Inter-OSS System Neighboring Cell
Data.
In the RNC in Pool management scenario, you need to configure neighboring cell data only on the
master RNC and then import the configured data. After the master RNC is configured, you can
synchronize the configuration of the backup RNC with the configuration of the master RNC using
the consistency check function. For detailed operations about the consistency check, see Checking
and Correcting the Differentiated Data Between the Master RNC and Backup or Overflow
RNCs.
On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose UMTS Application > Import Data >
Import Radio Network Planning Data (CME client mode) or CME > UMTS
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
392
7 Preparing Data
Application > Import Data > Import Radio Network Planning Data (U2000 client
Specify an NE version and TXT, XLS, or XLSM as the format of the file you want to import, and
click Add File to select a data planning file.
c.
Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to select an import mode.
d.
Table 3 describes the configuration objects in External Cell Type and Neighboring
Cell Relationship Type and the import modes.
NOTE:
When adding a GSM cell, the CME allocates a new index to the added GSM cell if the index of the
GSM cell conflicts with an existing index on the CME.
When importing neighbor relationships, the CME automatically skips those involving cells that do
not exist.
If cell indexes are not set for the external cell data in the imported file, the CME allocates the related
cell indexes based on whether the cell names exist on the CME. The allocation mechanism is as
follows:
If an external cell exists on the CME, the CME changes the cell index to the
existing one.
If an excel cell does not exist on the CME, the CME automatically allocates a
cell index.
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
on the
CME
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
in the
File
NodeB
Yes
Yes
The CME contains the existing data and the NodeB data in the
file and reallocates NodeB IDs.
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
The CME overwrites the existing data using the cell data in the
file.
No
Yes
The CME adds the cell data in the file. The principles for
selecting a cell template are as follows:
Cell
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
393
7 Preparing Data
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
on the
CME
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
in the
File
NodeB
Yes
Yes
The CME contains the existing data and the NodeB data in the
file and reallocates NodeB IDs.
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
The CME overwrites the existing data using the radio data of
the physical NodeBs in the file.
Yes
No
Whether
the
Object
Data
Exists on
the CME
Whether
Data Result on the CME After File Import
the Object
Data
Exists in
the File
Append
Yes
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
394
7 Preparing Data
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
on the
CME
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
in the
File
NodeB
Yes
Yes
The CME contains the existing data and the NodeB data in the
file and reallocates NodeB IDs.
No
Yes
No
Yes
For the external cell data, the CME adds the data in the
file.
NOTE:
BIDIRECTION in the file takes effect only in the
Append mode.
Yes
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
No
395
7 Preparing Data
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
on the
CME
Wheth
er
Data
Exists
in the
File
NodeB
Yes
Yes
The CME contains the existing data and the NodeB data in the
file and reallocates NodeB IDs.
No
Yes
Yes
Yes
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
Neighbor
relationships
are No
updated on a cell
basis.
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
Update
NOTE:
Delete
e.
f.
Then...
The import is
successful
The CME displays a message stating that the import is successful. Click Finish.
The import fails 1. The dialog box displays a message stating that error data exists in the data planning file. You
can view the error report or double-click the error record in the lower part of the dialog box
to open the data file. The CME locates the error data row in the file according to the error
information in the dialog box. Then, you can reconfigure data based on the information. If the
location information in the error record is incomplete, the CME cannot automatically locate
the row in the file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
396
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. After reconfiguring data, you can click Retry to import the data again.
----End
7.5.5.3 Co-MPT
When the new mode is UMTS, you need to use the summary data file for introducing RATs
(SRAN application) on the CME to configure data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Expanding Mode of a Co-MPT BTS in Batches.
Introducing RATs to Co-MPT Base Stations in Batches
Before exporting data based on a customized summary data file, use the function of customizing a summary
data file to customize a summary data file for RAT introduction. For details about how to customize a
summary data file, see Manually Customizing a Summary Data File.
In RAT introduction scenarios, you need to customize application maintenance mode parameters, including AT
and APPMNTMODE, of each RAT to a summary data file. When setting parameter values, you are advised to
set APPMNTMODE of the RAT to be introduced to TESTING.
Export co-MPT base station data to the summary data file for introducing RATs.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export co-MPT base station data.
Step 2 Select a scenario, RAT to be introduced to the co-MPT base station (for example, select LTE
for a co-MPT (GU) base station to be expanded to a co-MPT (GUL) base station), controller
version, base station version, base station to which RATs are to be introduced, and sample
base station, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
397
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
If you need to select base stations in batches by using a file, click Export to obtain an Excel file, edit
the file, and click Load to import it.
Operation
Summary data file, see Editing a Summary Data File (Customization Tool-based).
Import the summary data file in which data about RATs to be introduced has been edited into the CME.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
398
7 Preparing Data
Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the summary data file for
introducing RATs.
Step 2 Click
Step 3 Click Next and select co-MPT base stations for which you want to expand RATs.
If...
Then...
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
NOTE:
To generate scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To generate scripts of logical base stations in different files by base station, select One by
one.
b.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption
passwords are required when you loading projects.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you
have to enter encryption passwords by performing the following operations:
NOTE:
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the script on the
local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
1.
Select Yes.
2.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption
password as required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Step 4 (Optional and required when the new RATs include GSM) Click Next to set import options.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
399
7 Preparing Data
Set the start ID, frequency hopping attributes, and channel rules based on planned data.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME starts the import.
If...
Then...
The import
succeeds
1. View the failure report, or double-click the error message in the error list
to open the summary data file and locate the cell where the error data
exists.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After data is corrected, click Retry to import the summary data file again.
Follow-up Procedure
After introducing RATs to the base station, use the function of exporting auto-deployment
files to export the deployment list and data configuration file in the RAT introduction
scenario. For detailed operations, see Exporting Files Related to Base Station
Creation/RAT Introduction to Co-MPT Base Stations.
NOTE:
You can use either of the following methods to adjust other data after introducing RATs to a base station:
Export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction, and deliver them to the
live network for them to take effect. Then synchronize the data to the planned data area, adjust other
data, and then export an incremental script.
Do not export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction. Instead, continue
adjusting other data, and then use the function of exporting the site deployment list and data
configuration files to combine and export data in the RAT introduction and adjustment scenarios.
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment
data
Transmissi
on data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
400
Scena
rio
CoMPT
7 Preparing Data
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Radio data
Equipment
data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Device Data
Transmissi
on data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Transmission Data
Radio data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Radio Data
The following table list the configuration method when LTE works as the new mode.
Table 1.2 LTE working as the new mode
Scena
rio
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
CoMPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
Adjusting Co-MPT
Data
7.6.1.1 Separate-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in separate-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data
file for batch configuration (LTE application) on the CME. If only the RF-related equipment
data (RXU board/TRX/cell capacity) needs to be adjusted, you can adjust RF data using the
summary data file.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
401
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting base station bulk configuration data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
402
7 Preparing Data
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
403
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to adjust RF data using the summary data file, see Importing and
Exporting eNodeB RF Adjustment Data (standalone function).
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for RF Adjustment
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Set parameters displayed in the dialog box and specify the base stations whose data you want
to export.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
404
7 Preparing Data
Specify the RATs of the base stations whose data you want to export.
Specify the versions of the base stations and base station controller whose data you want
to export.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 3 Click Next. Then, specify the export mode, summary data file, and export path.
Table 3 Setting an export mode
Export Mode
Operation
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Select the file you want to import.
Step 3 Click Next, select the base stations for which you want to import the file.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
405
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 4 Optional: To generate configuration scripts in the wizard, select Export scripts and perform
the following operations:
a.
To save scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To save scripts of logical base stations in separate files by base station, select
One by one.
Scripts on the base station side (only base stations in SRAN10.1 and later support
splitting scripts by RRU chain/ring):
To generate RRU incremental scripts in different files by RRU chain/ring, select Split
scripts by RRU chain. The CME automatically generates common incremental
scripts and RRU chain/ring incremental scripts. For base stations whose RRU
chain/ring fails to be separated, the CME generates scripts that are not separated.
NOTE:
If the common incremental script of the base station depends on the incremental RRU chain/ring script
or if two incremental RRU chain/ring scripts are associated, scripts cannot be separated by RRU
chain/ring.
b.
c.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
iii.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
406
7 Preparing Data
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
NOTE:
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
default on the CME.
FH Attributes
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
preset start value and allocates them.
The CME generates data based on the FH type in the data file for RF adjustment. If the
FH type is not specified in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
selected in the wizard.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
Channel Rule
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot
Extension Cell, the configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME
automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2 on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively,
and allocates all the other timeslots in the cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
407
7 Preparing Data
Description
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Follow-up Procedure
If you select Split scripts by RRU chain in the wizard of importing RF adjustment data,
you need to activate common incremental scripts of a single base station during script
activation and then activate RRU chain/ring incremental scripts in sequence by task. The
CME does not allow you to activate multiple scripts of a base station simultaneously. After
activating a script, ensure that the script takes effect on the base station side and the
base station is connected before activating the next script.
7.6.1.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in co-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data file
for batch configuration (SRAN application) on the CME. If only the RF-related equipment
data (RXU board/TRX/cell capacity) needs to be adjusted, you can adjust RF data using the
summary data file.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
408
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details about how to use the summary data file for batch configuration (LTE application),
see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Exporting base station bulk configuration data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
409
7 Preparing Data
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
e.
f.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration
data from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
g.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
410
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
For details about how to adjust RF data using the summary data file, see Importing and
Exporting Co-MPT BTS RF Adjustment Data (standalone function).
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for RF Adjustment
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Set parameters displayed in the dialog box and specify the base stations whose data you want
to export.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
411
7 Preparing Data
Specify the RATs of the base stations whose data you want to export.
Specify the versions of the base stations and base station controller whose data you want
to export.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 3 Click Next. Then, specify the export mode, summary data file, and export path.
Table 3 Setting an export mode
Export Mode
Operation
Step 1 On the menu bar of the CME, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station RF Adjustment Data. A dialog box is
displayed.
Step 2 Select the file you want to import.
Step 3 Click Next, select the base stations for which you want to import the file.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
412
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Step 4 Optional: To generate configuration scripts in the wizard, select Export scripts and perform
the following operations:
a.
To save scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To save scripts of logical base stations in separate files by base station, select
One by one.
Scripts on the base station side (only base stations in SRAN10.1 and later support
splitting scripts by RRU chain/ring):
To generate RRU incremental scripts in different files by RRU chain/ring, select Split
scripts by RRU chain. The CME automatically generates common incremental
scripts and RRU chain/ring incremental scripts. For base stations whose RRU
chain/ring fails to be separated, the CME generates scripts that are not separated.
NOTE:
If the common incremental script of the base station depends on the incremental RRU chain/ring script
or if two incremental RRU chain/ring scripts are associated, scripts cannot be separated by RRU
chain/ring.
b.
c.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Select Yes.
ii.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
iii.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
413
7 Preparing Data
Description
Cell ID
The CME can automatically allocate IDs to new cells and TRXs.
TRX ID
Automatic allocation rules: After you enter a reference ID in the wizard, the CME
searches for available IDs from the reference ID and allocates them to new cells and
TRXs. For example, after allocating a reference TRX ID to the first TRX, the CME
generates a new ID by automatically adding 1 to the reference TRX ID and allocates the
new ID to the second TRX. If the generated ID has been used, the CME automatically
adds 1 to the ID until it is available and allocates the ID to the second TRX.
NOTE:
The minimum ID available under the NE selected in the wizard functions as the start value by
default on the CME.
FH Attributes
When the imported data file contains different NEs, the CME searches for available IDs from the
preset start value and allocates them.
The CME generates data based on the FH type in the data file for RF adjustment. If the
FH type is not specified in the data file, the CME generates data based on the FH type
selected in the wizard.
NOTE:
FH type has the following values: NO_FH, RF_FH, BaseBand_FH(BCCH HOP), and
BaseBand_FH(BCCH NOT HOP), indicating no FH, RF FH, baseband FH (BCCH TRX
involved), and baseband FH (BCCH TRX not involved), respectively.
Channel Rule
New Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment contains
new cells or you need to re-allocate channels of existing cells. For details about
channel allocation rules, see Channel Allocation Rules.
NOTE:
In the data file for RF adjustment, if Cell Extension Type is set to Double Timeslot
Extension Cell, the configuration of Channel Rule does not take effect. The CME
automatically allocates timeslots 0 and 2 on the BCCH TRX to the BCCH and SDCCH, respectively,
and allocates all the other timeslots in the cell to TCHs.
Existed Cells Channel Rule: configured when the data file for RF adjustment
contains only new TRXs or you need to add TRXs in an existing cell.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
When Channel Allocation Rule 0 for TRXs is selected, the CME re-allocates
all channels of the imported cells based on the channel allocation rule specified
by New Cells Channel Rule.
When Channel Allocation Rule 1 for TRXs is selected, the CME allocates
414
7 Preparing Data
Description
only channels of new TRXs based on the following rules:
1.
2.
3.
NOTE:
The rules do not take effect when the cell to which a TRX belongs is a double timeslot extension
cell.
The number of available channels is the difference between the sum of Number of PDCH and
Number of SDCCH specified in the data file for RF adjustment and the number of configured
channels of the cell to which new TRXs belong.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Follow-up Procedure
If you select Split scripts by RRU chain in the wizard of importing RF adjustment data,
you need to activate common incremental scripts of a single base station during script
activation and then activate RRU chain/ring incremental scripts in sequence by task. The
CME does not allow you to activate multiple scripts of a base station simultaneously. After
activating a script, ensure that the script takes effect on the base station side and the
base station is connected before activating the next script.
7.6.2.1 Separate-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in separate-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data
file for batch configuration (LTE application) on the CME to configure transmission data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
415
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Export Data
> Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Export Data > Export Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you want to
reconfigure in batches.
Step 2 Select the base station controller version, base station version, and related base station, and
click Next.
You can select base stations in the NE list. You can also click Load to quickly select base
stations defined in the file by importing a file.
NOTE:
When selecting base stations in the NE list, you can select base stations and then click Export to
export the selected base stations as a file for future selections.
If the file is unavailable when you select base stations by importing a file, you can click Export to
obtain a file, edit the file, and then click Load to import the file into the CME.
For details about rules for loading the file, see File Rules.
Then...
Select objects you want to export in the wizard directly 1. Select Custom MOC.
and enable the CME to export data based on the selected 2. Select objects you want to export and specify a save
objects.
path for the exported file.
NOTE:
This mode does not apply to GBTSs.
Export data based on the objects contained in a prepared 1. Select Bulk configuration template.
file.
2. In Bulk configuration data file, select the
prepared file and export configuration data from the
CME based on the MOs in this file.
3. In Export path, specify a save path for the file that
contains the exported data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
416
7 Preparing Data
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Import the Abis interface data that has been reconfigured in batches.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose GSM Application > Import Data
> Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME > GSM
Application > Import Data > Import Abis Bulk Configuration Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the Abis data that has been
reconfigured in batches.
Step 2 Perform operations as required.
If you need to...
Then...
Select the file you want to import and click Next. The CME starts to import the
file.
1. Select the file you want to import and select Export script by wizard.
2. Click Next.
3. Set the script generation information.
NOTE:
a.
NOTE:
When multiple base stations share MOs at the bottom link layer, such as MOs ETHIP,
PPPLNK, and MPGRP, if the script generation mode is set to One by one, primary
information (information about the subrack and slot numbers of an interface board) about
these MOs cannot be modified if the related IP addresses are not changed. Otherwise, data
may conflict after being imported into the CME.
b.
c.
d.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects,
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the
script on the local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
1.
Select Yes.
2.
417
7 Preparing Data
Then...
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
e.
f.
7.6.2.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in co-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data file
for batch configuration (SRAN application) on the CME to configure transmission data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
418
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
419
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
420
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
7.6.3.1 Separate-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in separate-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data
file for batch configuration (LTE application) on the CME to configure radio data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting eNodeB Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting eNodeB Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose LTE Application > Export Data
> Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME >
LTE Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
421
7 Preparing Data
Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data. For
detailed operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration.
If you want to change the values of multiple parameters to the same value, for example, in scenarios where you
want to change device IP addresses, you can convert the summary data file into the MOC-integration view and
then edit the data. For detailed operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration
(MOC-Integration View).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
422
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
7.6.3.2 Co-MPT
When the original mode is LTE in co-MPT scenarios, you need to use the summary data file
for batch configuration (SRAN application) on the CME to configure radio data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
----End
For details, see Importing and Exporting Co-MPT BTS Batch Configuration Data.
Importing and Exporting Co-MPT Base Station Data for Batch Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data
(CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Export
Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to configure data in batches, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
423
7 Preparing Data
Step 2 Select a reconfiguration scenario, RAT of NEs, versions of base stations and base station
controllers, and list of base stations. Then, click Next.
If you select the GSM base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Abis interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Abis
Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration.
If you select the UMTS base station controller and base station data, the implementation
of the function is the same as that of importing and exporting Iub interface data of a
single-mode base station. For detailed operations, see Importing and Exporting Iub Data
for Batch Reconfiguration.
If two or more RATs are selected, base station data and controller data cannot be
reconfigured together.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
424
7 Preparing Data
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Step 5 After the export is complete, click Finish.
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data.If
parameters to be reconfigured for each base station are the same and numbers of parameter records are the
same, it is convenient to reconfigure them in the MOC-integration view. For detailed operations, see Editing a
Summary Data File for Batch Configuration (MOC-Integration View) .
Then...
You have selected GSM The CME starts the wizard for importing Abis interface data. For detailed operations, see
base station controllers Importing and Exporting Abis Interface Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
and base stations in the
preceding step
You have selected
The CME starts the wizard for importing Iub interface data. For detailed operations, see
UMTS base station
Importing and Exporting Iub Data for Batch Reconfiguration .
controllers and base
stations in the preceding
step
You have selected only
base stations in the
preceding step
The CME starts the wizard for importing base station data for batch configuration. The
procedure is as follows:
1. Select the file you want to import and click Next.
NOTE:
The CME supports the file import even if the RAT contained in the file is different from the selected
RAT. For example, if GSM is selected but the RAT contained in the file is UMTS or LTE, the file can
still be imported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
425
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Select the base stations for which you want to import the file and click Next.
NOTE:
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import. When
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration
data has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on
the error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
Separate
-MPT
Equipment,
transmissio
n, and
radio data
Co-
Equipment,
Adjusting Co-MPT
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
426
7 Preparing Data
Scena
rio
Data
Type
CME Template
Reference
MPT
transmissio
n, and
radio data
Data
7.6.4.1 Separate-MPT
To add LTE as a new mode using a summary template for new site deployment is similar to
add an eNodeB. For detailed operations, see section "Creating eNodeBs" in "Creating Base
Stations" in 3900 Series Base Station Initial Configuration Guide.
1
Open the summary data file in the basic scenario by using the function of customizing a summary
data file.
a.
On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (CME client
mode) or CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to open the summary data file.
b.
Perform operations.
Scenario Basic Summary Template is the minimum set of configuration parameters for
base station creation. After you select information required for creating base stations, such as the
link mode, telecom operator sharing mode, and security information on the customization wizard,
the CME automatically adds related parameters to the summary data file according to your selection.
You can use the customization wizard to combine base station creation scenarios, which reduces
redundant parameters generated in the summary data file.
Other default summary data files are classified by scenario and contain all parameters in the related
scenarios. Therefore, the following problems may occur:
A summary data file fails to be verified due to data collision when the
customization wizard is used.
You can learn the introduction to scenarios by checking the information
displayed on the GUI of the summary data file.
c.
After the configuration is complete, click OK. The main window for customizing a summary data
file is displayed, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
427
7 Preparing Data
Tab page, which displays a set of NE configuration parameters. This area can be customized.
Table, which lists the mappings between the parameter groups and parameters in a summary data file
and the NE configuration objects and parameters, respectively.
NE configuration objects and parameters are not editable. Parameter groups and parameters in a
summary data file can be customized.
: indicates a modified record.
: indicates an added record. Such tags will not be displayed next time after you save the summary
data file.
NOTE:
When the values of NE MOC and NE Attribute are empty in a record, the parameter is a new one in the
summary data file and there is no mapping between the parameter and NE configuration objects.
This parameter is referenced by other configuration parameters. If this parameter is not referenced, the parameter
value does not take effect.
If multiple NE configuration parameters are in the same summary parameter group and share the same name, they
are combined into a column in the generated summary data file.
Editable records are highlighted in white; Records that are not editable are highlighted in
can be deleted but cannot be modified are highlighted in
2.
; Records that
Start the wizard for customizing a summary data file, and customize basic and transport parameters
in a summary data file.
NOTE:
The parameter specifications defined in the basic base station creation wizard must be lower than those
provided by NEs. If the planned data exceeds the defined parameter specifications, you can manually
customize data after completing operations by following the wizard.
a.
Use the customization wizard to customize basic and transport data. Figure 2 shows an
operation example.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
428
7 Preparing Data
Tip1
Tip2
b.
Configure data based on the planned data in each step on the wizard.
Optional:
Use the customization wizard to customize RAN sharing data. Figure 3 shows an operation
example.
Figure 3 Operations in the RAN sharing wizard
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
429
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
Parameters with * in the wizard are mandatory. Optional parameters are configured based on site
requirements.
After the operations in the wizard are complete, a customization report is generated. The report displays
user-specified information, automatically added MOs and planned parameter values (excluding default
values), and information that needs to be set manually.
3.
(Optional and required when the summary data file customized on the wizard does not contain all
parameters to be configured) Manually customize parameters to be configured in the summary data
file.
If you need
to...
Then...
The parameter marked in red is the primary key parameter under the configuration
object. When adding a parameter, you must add the primary key parameter under the
configuration object to which the parameter belongs.
Only one configuration object can be customized on the XXXX Pattern orXXXX List tab
page.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
430
7 Preparing Data
One configuration object can be customized only on one tab page or on one tab page and
the Common Data tab page.
Click
to verify validity of the edited summary data file. Then, modify the file based on the
verification result.
If the verification fails, you can double-click the error message. Then, the CME automatically locates
the error. You have to rectify the error until the verification succeeds.
NOTE:
If an alarm is generated indicating that the branch parameter does not exist in the verification result, you
need to determine whether to customize the parameter to the summary data file based on the planned
data. The alarm does not affect the subsequent operation of saving data.
Open the summary data file in the basic scenario by using the function of customizing a summary
data file.
a.
On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (CME client
mode) or CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (U2000 client mode). A
dialog box is displayed for you to open the summary data file.
b.
Perform operations.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
431
7 Preparing Data
Scenario Basic Summary Template is the minimum set of configuration parameters for
base station creation. After you select information required for creating base stations, such as the
link mode, telecom operator sharing mode, and security information on the customization wizard,
the CME automatically adds related parameters to the summary data file according to your selection.
You can use the customization wizard to combine base station creation scenarios, which reduces
redundant parameters generated in the summary data file.
Other default summary data files are classified by scenario and contain all parameters in the related
scenarios. Therefore, the following problems may occur:
A summary data file fails to be verified due to data collision when the
customization wizard is used.
You can learn the introduction to scenarios by checking the information
displayed on the GUI of the summary data file.
c.
After the configuration is complete, click OK. The main window for customizing a summary data
file is displayed, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Window for customizing a summary data file
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
432
7 Preparing Data
Tab page, which displays a set of NE configuration parameters. This area can be customized.
Table, which lists the mappings between the parameter groups and parameters in a summary data file
and the NE configuration objects and parameters, respectively.
NE configuration objects and parameters are not editable. Parameter groups and parameters in a
summary data file can be customized.
NOTE:
When the values of NE MOC and NE Attribute are empty in a record, the parameter is a new one in the
summary data file and there is no mapping between the parameter and NE configuration objects.
This parameter is referenced by other configuration parameters. If this parameter is not referenced, the parameter
value does not take effect.
If multiple NE configuration parameters are in the same summary parameter group and share the same name, they
are combined into a column in the generated summary data file.
Editable records are highlighted in white; Records that are not editable are highlighted in
can be deleted but cannot be modified are highlighted in
2.
; Records that
Start the wizard for customizing a summary data file, and customize basic, transport, and security
data in the file.
NOTE:
The parameter specifications defined in the basic base station creation wizard must be lower than those
provided by NEs. If the planned data exceeds the defined parameter specifications, you can manually
customize data after completing operations by following the wizard.
a.
Use the customization wizard to customize basic and transport data. Figure 2 shows an
operation example.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
433
7 Preparing Data
Tip1
Tip2
b.
Configure data based on the planned data in each step on the wizard.
Use the security wizard to customize security-related data. Figure 3 shows an operation example.
Figure 3 Operations on the wizard
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
434
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
When configuring data in the wizard, observe the following:
Tip 1
Steps in a wizard to be emphasized on are marked with Tip in the preceding figure. You can view
related descriptions based on site requirements.
When multi-level CA certificates in the certificate chain provided by you are stored separately,
configure multiple CA records.
When you provide a certificate chain file, configure a certificate chain record.
Tip 2
Configure security gateway information records based on collected IKE and IPsec algorithms and
combination status of these algorithms provided by you. For example, two IKE algorithms, two IPsec
algorithms, and only three IKE and IPsec algorithm combination methods are provided. You need to
configure only three security gateway information records.
Tip 3
Sequence Number of IPsec tunnel of IPsec tunnels configured for the same port cannot be
duplicate.
Tip 4
c.
After the operations in the wizard are complete, a customization report is generated. The report
displays user-specified information, automatically added MOs and planned parameter values
(excluding default values), and information that needs to be set manually.
Optional:
Use the customization wizard to customize RAN sharing data. Figure 4 shows an operation
example.
Figure 4 Operations in the RAN sharing wizard
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
435
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
Parameters with * in the wizard are mandatory. Optional parameters are configured based on site
requirements.
After the operations in the wizard are complete, a customization report is generated. The report displays
user-specified information, automatically added MOs and planned parameter values (excluding default
values), and information that needs to be set manually.
3.
(Optional and required when the summary data file customized on the wizard does not contain all
parameters to be configured) Manually customize parameters to be configured in the summary data
file.
If you need
to...
Then...
The parameter marked in red is the primary key parameter under the configuration
object. When adding a parameter, you must add the primary key parameter under the
configuration object to which the parameter belongs.
Only one configuration object can be customized on the XXXX Pattern orXXXX List tab
page.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
436
7 Preparing Data
One configuration object can be customized only on one tab page or on one tab page and
the Common Data tab page.
Click
to verify validity of the edited summary data file. Then, modify the file based on the
verification result.
If the verification fails, you can double-click the error message. Then, the CME automatically locates
the error. You have to rectify the error until the verification succeeds.
NOTE:
If an alarm is generated indicating that the branch parameter does not exist in the verification result, you
need to determine whether to customize the parameter to the summary data file based on the planned
data. The alarm does not affect the subsequent operation of saving data.
In Microsoft Office Excel 2003, the macro function must be enabled and the macro
security level must be set to Medium.
In Microsoft Office Excel 2007 and Excel 2010, the macro function must be enabled.
For detailed operations, see Setting the Macro Security Level in an Excel File.
Step 3 (Optional) Edit the data that has been negotiated with telecom operators in the LLD data file.
Only eNodeBs support the LLD data file.
You need to convert a summary data file into an LLD data file first. After configuring data in
the LLD data file, convert the LLD data file into a summary data file. For the mapping
between the LLD data file and the summary data file, see Introduction to the LLD Data File
and Summary Data File.
NOTE:
This function is available only after you select the LLD column of related parameters when customizing
a summary data file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
437
7 Preparing Data
to convert it into an
The sheet named Common Data maps COMMON. The other sheet names remain
unchanged.
dd.
NOTE:
By default, the CME provides the parameter values of Qos based on the network design. You can
manually delete records from or add records to Qos as required. After the LLD data file has been
converted into the summary data file, parameters are automatically edited in the corresponding locations
in the summary data file according to the conversion principles shown in Figure 1. The existing data in
the summary data file is overwritten.
Figure 1 Conversion principles for the parameters under the Qos object
If Service Type has two records IKE and Ping under the Qos object in the LLD data file,
the mapping (1) does not map the two records.
ee.
Click
data file.
Edit global data, which is the same for all base stations, on the Common
Data sheet. Such parameters include the telecom operator information and
OSS IP address.
ff.
Edit basic information, which is different for all base stations, on the Base Station
Transport Data sheet or the MO list sheet (XXXX List). For example:
Edit the basic base station information including the base station name and type on the
Base Station Transport Data sheet.
Edit base station functions and locations on the corresponding MO list sheet ( XXXX
List).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
438
7 Preparing Data
The configuration data of devices uses the values in the base station
template. Therefore, you need to set the name of the prepared base station
template on the Base Station Transport Data sheet.
NOTE:
Only the default template name is displayed in the drop-down list for selecting a template in the
summary data file. Therefore, before selecting a user-defined template, you have to click
to add the user-defined template name to the drop-down
list.
Information about the user-defined template must be consistent with that about the existing template on
the CME.
gg.
Edit clock data and time data on the Common Data sheet.
Edit the data planned for each base station, such as the IP address, subnet, and port
number, on the Base Station Transport Data sheet.
b.
Edit the parameters for the MOs corresponding to each interface on the corresponding MO sheets
(XXXX List or XXXX Pattern). For example, device IP addresses and SCTP links are MOs.
If the value of a parameter on the XXXX Pattern sheet varies among base stations, you
can click
and select the parameter that needs to be referenced.
Microsoft Excel automatically generates the reference path for the parameter in the
summary data file. Figure 2 provides an example for using the reference function.
Advantage of the reference function: The value of one parameter can be referenced on
multiple XXXX Pattern sheets. Therefore, after a reference relationship is set, you only
need to change the referenced parameter value and do not need to modify the
parameters on the XXXX Pattern sheets even if the referenced parameter value
changes.
Restriction of the reference function:
If a branch parameter has been set to be referenced by another parameters, the summary
data file does not enable or disable the parameters controlled by the branch parameter.
The CME will still check accuracy of all the parameters during the import.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
439
7 Preparing Data
Under the DevIPPattern object in the preceding figure, to retain the parameter value of
Mask on port 0 in slot 7 of subrack 0 in cabinet 0 the same as the parameter value of
PeerMask under the OMCH object on the Base Station Transport Data sheet, you have
to enter the path of the referenced parameter eNodeB Transport
Data\OMCH\PeerMask as the parameter value of Mask on port 0 in slot 7 of subrack 0
in cabinet 0. The CME assigns a parameter value based on the reference path.
During IP route configuration, if the value obtained after a logic AND operation is
performed on the IP address and subnet mask is not equal to the IP address, you need to
use the macro function
address that meets the rule.
The IP address verification rule is the same as the NE configuration rule. That is, after a
logical AND operation is performed on the IP address and subnet mask, the obtained
value is equal to the IP address.
For detailed operations related to macro functions, see Figure 3.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
440
7 Preparing Data
Figure 3 Settings
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
441
7 Preparing Data
Specify the sheet, parameter group, and parameter name that correspond to the IP addresses
and subnet masks to be calculated.
Specify locations in the summary data file for the calculated IP addresses and subnet masks.
To use the calculated IP addresses and subnet masks to overwrite existing data in the
summary data file, perform the following operations:
To add a row next to the parameter specified in step 1 and show the calculated IP
addresses and subnet masks in the added row, perform the following operations:
Click Add and add a conversion rule. You can repeat steps 1 and 2 to add multiple
conversion rules.
Non-32-bit subnet mask: After you enter IP addresses and subnet masks, a logic AND
operation is performed on them. The obtained network codes replace the IP addresses,
and the subnet masks are replaced with 255.255.255.255.
32-bit subnet mask: The IP addresses remain the same. The entered subnet masks are
replaced with 255.255.255.255.
Click OK. Excel starts the calculation based on the preset information.
Step 8 Configure automatic deployment data about the base stations to be created.
Click the Auto Deployment sheet and set the value of each parameter based on the planned
data.
Step 9 Close the modified summary data file.
442
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose LTE Application > Import Data >
Import Base Station Summary Data (CME client mode) or CME > LTE
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Summary Data (U2000 client
mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to create base stations using a summary data
file.
Step 2 Click
If redundant device objects exist after the data for creating base stations in the summary data
file and data in the template are combined, after Delete redundant RF equipment data is
selected, the CME automatically deletes the device objects and subobjects that have not been
referenced by the cell.
Step 3 Click Next and select base stations you want to create.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME starts the import.
If...
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose LTE Application > Import Data >
Import Base Station Summary Data (CME client mode) or CME > LTE
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Summary Data (U2000 client
mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to create base stations using a summary data
file.
Step 2 Click
If redundant device objects exist after the data for creating base stations in the summary data
file and data in the template are combined, after Delete redundant RF equipment data is
selected, the CME automatically deletes the device objects and subobjects that have not been
referenced by the cell.
Step 3 Click Next and select base stations you want to create.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME starts the import.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
443
7 Preparing Data
If...
Then...
The import is
successful
Click Finish.
1. You can view the error report. You can also double-click an error message in the error list
area. The CME opens the imported file and locates the error data cell in the file.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After the modification, click Retry to import the file.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose CME > LTE Application >
Import Data > Import Radio Network Planning Data (U2000 client mode) or
LTE Application > Import Data > Import Radio Network Planning Data (CME
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import planned radio data.
Step 2 Click Add, select the prepared radio data planning file, and click Next. A dialog box is
displayed for you to select eNodeBs.
If you edit the eNodeBs to be imported on the SiteList sheet in the file, the dialog box
displays the eNodeBs that are available in both the file and the current planned data area.
By default, the eNodeBs on the SiteList sheet are selected.
If you do not edit the SiteList sheet in the file, the dialog box displays the eNodeBs that
are available in both the file and the current planned data area. By default, all eNodeBs
are selected.
Step 3 Select the eNodeBs you want to import and click Next.
Step 4 Select cells and neighbor relationships you want to import into the CME, and select an import
mode. Then, click Next.
After you select an import mode, the CME uses the primary key (such as cell ID) to determine
whether the objects exist on the CME and in the file, and then determines how to process the
data. Table 1 describes the import modes and import results.
Table 1 Description of import modes
Import Mode
Whether the
Object Data
Exists on the
CME
Whether the
Object Data
Exists in the
File
Append
Yes
Yes
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
444
7 Preparing Data
Whether the
Object Data
Exists on the
CME
Whether the
Object Data
Exists in the
File
No
Yes
For the external cell data, the CME adds the data in the
file.
NOTE:
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
NOTE:
Neighbor
relationships
are No
updated on a cell
basis.
The CME overwrites the existing data with the data in the
file.
Yes
No
Update
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
445
7 Preparing Data
station
Whether the
Object Data
Exists on the
CME
Whether the
Object Data
Exists in the
File
Yes
Yes
No
Yes
Yes
No
controller
Delete
Step 5 The CME starts to import the data. During the import, the CME automatically corrects
external LTE cell data based on the adjusted source cell data to ensure data consistency. After
the data is imported, click Finish.
Step 6
Table 2 Operation description
If...
Then...
The dialog box displays errors in the data planning file. You can view the error report, or
double-click an error record in the lower part of the dialog box to open the file. The CME
locates the error data row in the file. Then, you can reconfigure data. If the location
information in the error record is incomplete, the CME cannot automatically locate the
row in the file.
----End
7.6.4.2 Co-MPT
When the new mode is LTE, you need to use the summary data file for introducing RATs
(SRAN application) on the CME to configure data.
The configuration procedure is as follows:
Step 1 Customize and obtain the summary data file based on the mode transition planning results.
Step 2 Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
Step 3 Import the template file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
446
7 Preparing Data
----End
For details, see Expanding Mode of a Co-MPT BTS in Batches.
Introducing RATs to Co-MPT Base Stations in Batches
Before exporting data based on a customized summary data file, use the function of customizing a summary
data file to customize a summary data file for RAT introduction. For details about how to customize a
summary data file, see Manually Customizing a Summary Data File.
In RAT introduction scenarios, you need to customize application maintenance mode parameters, including AT
and APPMNTMODE, of each RAT to a summary data file. When setting parameter values, you are advised to
set APPMNTMODE of the RAT to be introduced to TESTING.
Export co-MPT base station data to the summary data file for introducing RATs.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Export Data > Export Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export co-MPT base station data.
Step 2 Select a scenario, RAT to be introduced to the co-MPT base station (for example, select LTE
for a co-MPT (GU) base station to be expanded to a co-MPT (GUL) base station), controller
version, base station version, base station to which RATs are to be introduced, and sample
base station, as shown in Figure 1.
Figure 1 Export expansion data
NOTE:
If you need to select base stations in batches by using a file, click Export to obtain an Excel file, edit
the file, and click Load to import it.
Operation
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
447
7 Preparing Data
Option
Operation
Summary data file, see Editing a Summary Data File (Customization Tool-based).
Import the summary data file in which data about RATs to be introduced has been edited into the CME.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion
Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application >
Import Data > Import Base Station Multimode Expansion Data (U2000
client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to import the summary data file for
introducing RATs.
Step 2 Click
Step 3 Click Next and select co-MPT base stations for which you want to expand RATs.
If...
Then...
The imported
summary data file
contains only data
about base stations
The imported
summary data file
contains data about
both base station
controllers and base
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If Best effort is selected, the CME skips the error information and continues the import.
448
If...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
When the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
stations
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
NOTE:
To generate scripts of logical base stations in the same file, select Batch.
To generate scripts of logical base stations in different files by base station, select One by
one.
b.
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption
passwords are required when you loading projects.
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you
have to enter encryption passwords by performing the following operations:
NOTE:
If an encrypted password has been set for the exproted script, you cannot check the script on the
local PC. Instead, you have to check it using the script executor.
1.
Select Yes.
2.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption
password as required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
3.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Step 4 (Optional and required when the new RATs include GSM) Click Next to set import options.
Set the start ID, frequency hopping attributes, and channel rules based on planned data.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME starts the import.
If...
Then...
1. View the failure report, or double-click the error message in the error list to
open the summary data file and locate the cell where the error data exists.
2. Modify error data based on the error message.
3. After data is corrected, click Retry to import the summary data file again.
Follow-up Procedure
After introducing RATs to the base station, use the function of exporting auto-deployment
files to export the deployment list and data configuration file in the RAT introduction
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
449
7 Preparing Data
scenario. For detailed operations, see Exporting Files Related to Base Station
Creation/RAT Introduction to Co-MPT Base Stations.
NOTE:
You can use either of the following methods to adjust other data after introducing RATs to a base station:
Export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction, and deliver them to the
live network for them to take effect. Then synchronize the data to the planned data area, adjust other
data, and then export an incremental script.
Do not export the deployment list and data configuration file for RAT introduction. Instead, continue
adjusting other data, and then use the function of exporting the site deployment list and data
configuration files to combine and export data in the RAT introduction and adjustment scenarios.
In the CME tool, choose CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Date File.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
450
7 Preparing Data
Click
1.
2.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
451
7 Preparing Data
For details about how to customize a summary data file, see Customizing eNodeB Batch
Configuration Summary Data File.
Customizing a Summary Data File for Batch eNodeB Configuration
Step 1 On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (CME client mode)
or CME > Advanced > Customize Summary Data File (U2000 client mode). A dialog box
is displayed for you to open the summary data file.
Step 2 Perform operations as required.
To use a default summary data file, select related information in sequence. To select
information for a single-mode base station or co-MPT base station (LO), perform the
following operations:
For the co-MPT base station (LO), select Default, Co-MPT BTS Bulk
Configuration, LTE, and base station version.
Step 3 After the configuration is complete, click OK. The main window for customizing a summary
data file is displayed, as shown in Figure 1.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
452
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
Parameters marked with * in area 3 are mandatory, and parameters in gray cannot be deleted or
modified.
Then...
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
453
7 Preparing Data
The parameter marked in red is the primary key parameter under the configuration
object. When adding a parameter, you must add the primary key parameter under the
configuration object to which the parameter belongs.
Only one configuration object can be customized on the XXXX Pattern orXXXX List tab
page.
Step 6 Click
to verify validity of the edited summary data file. Then, modify the file based on the
verification result.
If the verification fails, you can double-click the error message. Then, the CME automatically
locates the error. You have to rectify the error until the verification succeeds.
NOTE:
If an alarm is generated indicating that the branch parameter does not exist in the verification result, you
need to determine whether to customize the parameter to the summary data file based on the planned
data. The alarm does not affect the subsequent operation of saving data.
1. Export related configuration data based on the summary data file for batch eNodeB configuration. For detailed
operations, see Export base station data to the summary data file.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
454
7 Preparing Data
2. Reconfigure data in the summary data file for batch eNodeB configuration based on site requirements and then
import the edited file into the CME. For detailed operations, see Import the modified summary data file.
Based on the customized template, export the data to be adjusted and specify data in the
template file as planned.
a.
hh.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose LTE Application > Export Data
> Export Base Station Bulk Configuration Data (CME client mode) or CME >
LTE Application > Export Data > Export Base Station Bulk Configuration
Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the data you
want to reconfigure in batches.
Step 2 Select the batch reconfiguration scenario, base station version, and related base stations, and
click Next.
NOTE:
If users need to adjust only global radio parameters, cell parameters, and cell algorithm parameters, set
Adjust Data by to Cell. Then, the CME will automatically displays cell-related parameters, which
helps users filter and select cells.
Step 3 Select Custom MOC, set objects you want to export, and specify a save path for the exported
file.
NOTE:
To export data based on the objects contained in a prepared summary data file, perform the following
steps: For details about the export mechanism, see Introduction to the Export Mechanism for
Exporting Data Based On an Existing File.
a.
b.
In Bulk configuration data file, select the prepared file and export configuration data
from the CME based on the MOs in this file.
c.
In Export path, specify a save path for the file that contains the exported data.
Step 4 Click Next. The CME verifies the configuration data to be exported.
If the verification fails, the CME does not export data.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
455
7 Preparing Data
Open the local summary data file and reconfigure data in the summary data file based on planned data. For
detailed operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration.
If you want to change the values of multiple parameters to the same value, for example, in scenarios where you
want to change device IP addresses, you can convert the summary data file into the MOC-integration view and
then edit the data. For detailed operations, see Editing a Summary Data File for Batch Configuration
(MOC-Integration View).
the import is complete, the CME rolls back only incorrect base station data.
If Best effort is not selected, the CME rolls back all the imported data if the import fails.
If the CME displays a message stating that the operation is successful, configuration data
has been successfully imported.
If the CME displays a message stating that the import failed, base station configuration
data failed to be imported. If this occurs, you have to reconfigure the data based on the
error information.
NOTE:
In the error message list, you can:
Click an error message to view the details at the bottom of the wizard.
Double-click an error message to switch to the corresponding location in the imported file. Then,
reconfigure the data based on the error information.
----End
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS Application
> Export Data > Export Binding Relation Data (CME client mode) or CME > SRAN
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
456
7 Preparing Data
Application > MBTS Application > Export Data > Export Binding Relation Data
(U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export the binding relationship
table.
Step 2 Select separate-MPT base stations whose binding relationships you want to export.
a.
Select a separate-MPT base station type from the MBTS type drop-down
list.
ii.
Select one or more separate-MPT base stations whose binding relationships you
want to export.
Step 3 Click Next. A dialog box is displayed for you to specify a save path.
Step 4 Set the save path for the file you want to export.
Step 5 Click Next. The CME starts to export the data.
Step 6 When the export is successful, click Finish.
Step 1 Set the names of base stations to be bound in NE1, NE2, and NE3, set the
deployment ID, and select a target RAT type from the MBTS Type drop-down list.
LTE_TDD in the MBTS Type drop-down list indicates only the LTE TDD base stations
that are supported since SRAN11.0, and no LTE FDD cells can be added for such base
stations.
Step 2 After editing the binding relationship table, save and close it.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose SRAN Application > MBTS
Application > Import Data > Import MBTS Relationship Data (CME client
mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > Import Data >
Import MBTS Relationship Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed
for you to import the binding relationship table.
Step 2 Select the binding relationship file you want to import, and click Next. The CME starts
checking the file format and importing the file.
Step 3 When the import is successful, click Finish.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
457
7 Preparing Data
NOTE:
If the import fails, click a link to view the error report. After modifying data based on the report,
click Retry to return to the step where the error occurs, and perform the operation again.
In the BSC node redundancy scenario, if the primary and secondary homing base stations are
available in the planned data area, only the primary homing base station can be bound. If the
secondary homing base station is bound, an error message is displayed. If only the primary homing
base station or secondary homing base station is available in the planned data area, either can be
bound.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the current data area or a planned data area, choose Advanced >
Consistency Check (CME client mode) or CME > Advanced > Consistency Check
(U2000 client mode). The data consistency check window is displayed, Figure 1 shows the
window.
Figure 1 Data consistency check window
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Then...
1. Click
458
If you need
to...
7 Preparing Data
Then...
2. Set the task name, and select the NEs whose data is to be checked.
NOTE:
You can click
to load common objects in batches. For details, see
Loading Common Objects in Batches.
3. Click Next, and select a filter.For detailed operations about filters, see Managing Rule
Groups.
4. Select related check rules.
After you select a check rule, the details about the rule are displayed in the right
pane.
NOTE:
For common check rules, you can click Save As in the upper right part to save
the check rules as a filter.
5. Click Next. The CME displays the selected NEs and check rules.
When you check data about multiple NEs, related check items may be different. You
can select the required check items for NEs.
6. Click Finish. The CME starts to check data.
Restart a task
Right-click a task from the historical check records in the left pane, and choose Restart
Task from the shortcut menu. The CME starts to check data.
Then...
Autofix
The CME automatically fixes all check results for related check rules.
NOTE:
Operation Type is Autofix for a check rule that has specified how to modify the check result and
has only one check result.
1. Click
2. Select the required fix type. The CME then automatically reconfigures data.
For details about the mapping between the options in the autofix wizard and check rules,
see Introduction to the autofix Options.
Edit
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
459
7 Preparing Data
If Operation Type
of a result
record is
displayed as...
Then...
Refresh
You can select check results to be fixed as required. The CME then automatically
refreshes these check results.
NOTE:
The operation type is defined as Refresh for the check rules whose check result can be either fixed
or not fixed.
Double-click the data record to open the data update wizard, and reconfigure the data by
using the wizard.
NOTE:
The CME corrects all records for one check rule by default. In addition, the CME allows you to
check a maximum of 9999 records in the update wizard at a time. If you want to check more than
9999 records, the CME does not display the additional records, but it corrects all records.
You can click Edit to add or delete records in the update wizard in the displayed dialog box.
The CME does not correct deleted records. In addition, the CME adds the records that have not been
added to the update wizard. The total number of records cannot exceed 9999.
If a security policy record is selected, the CME displays the parameter column name as
Parameter Name (Reference Value) in the Refresh wizard of the security policy.
You can check both the reference values and current values of parameters to be
reconfigured.
The check results can only be viewed.
None
NOTE:
You can perform the following operations in area 3 in Figure 1 as required:
To filter a large number of check results by type for easier browsing, click
name.
To export the check results as a file, right-click in area 3 and choose Export Data from the
shortcut menu.
Follow-up Procedure
After creating two or more data consistency check tasks, you can select two tasks in the
task list in area 2 of the Figure 1 area at the same time, right-click them, and choose
Compare Task Result from the shortcut menu to compare the check results.
NOTE:
You can also compare the check results of two tasks in the following method:
Right-click a task and choose Choose to compare on left window from the shortcut menu.
Right-click the other task, and choose the related option from the shortcut menu to compare it with
the selected task.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
460
7 Preparing Data
Step 1 On the menu bar of the current data area or planned data area, choose SRAN
Application > MBTS Application > MBTS Consistency Check (CME client
mode) or CME > SRAN Application > MBTS Application > MBTS Consistency
Check (U2000 client mode). A window is displayed for you to perform operations.
If you need
to...
Then...
Perform 2.
Perform 3.
Create a consistency
check task
Perform 2 and 8.
Step 2 (Optional and required when the default check parameter configurations do not meet your
requirements) Set check rule parameters.
If you need to... Then...
Set check rule
parameters
1. Click
Power Overload: indicates whether the carrier power on the RXU can exceed the
maximum value designed for the hardware. When excessive power is allowed, the
RXU can provide higher transmit power by sharing power between carriers.
General Spec.: indicates that the temperature is higher than or equal to 50C.
3. Click OK.
Set the error severity
of check rules
1. Click
2. Click the Levels tab, and set the error severity of check rules.
Error: A fault that currently does not affect services occurs and a corrective action must
be taken to prevent a more serious fault.
Major: A service-affecting fault occurs. If the fault is not rectified in time, it will lead to
a serious result.
3. Click OK.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
461
7 Preparing Data
Step 3 (Optional and required when the default check parameter configurations do not meet your
requirements) Manage rule groups.
a.
Click
jj.
Select a multimode base station type from the MBTS type drop-down list. The
existing rule groups are displayed in the left pane of the dialog box and the related
check rules are displayed in the right pane.
kk.
Select a rule group from the left pane of the dialog box, and click Delete.
1. Select a rule group from the left pane of the dialog box, and select or clear check rules
from the right pane.
2. Click Save.
ll.
Step 4 Click
Click Close.
. The wizard dialog box is displayed.
Step 5 Set the task name in the Check task name area, select a multimode base station type from
the MBTS type drop-down list, and select multimode base stations to be checked from the list
in the lower part of the area.
NOTE:
In the BSC node redundancy scenario, if the primary and secondary homing base stations are available
under the MBTS, only the primary homing base station is displayed in the NE list. If only one of the
primary and secondary homing base stations is available in the MBTS, the base station is displayed in
the NE list.
Select a rule group from the Rule group drop-down list. All related check
rules are displayed in the lower part.
mm.
nn.
(Optional and required when you want to use the modified rule group for future
checks) Click Save As to save the rules as a rule group.
After you exit the wizard, you can view the new rule group by performing 3.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
462
7 Preparing Data
Reconfigure the NE to be checked: Clear all check rules related to the NE.
Modify a check rule for one or multiple NEs: Clear the rule.
Step 8 Click Finish. The CME starts to check the data and displays check results.
If Operation Type in a
data record is
displayed as...
Refresh
Then...
Double-click the data record. The CME reconfigures the data automatically
according to the primary mode set for the multi-mode base station.
NOTE:
For the conflict result record of the RXU resources, double-click the record. The dialog box
for reconfiguring the RXU resources is displayed. You need to reallocate the RXU resources
before the CME starts reconfiguring the data automatically.
Edit
Double-click the data record to open the general data configuration window, and
manually reconfigure the data.
None
To filter a large number of check results by type for easier browsing, click
name.
To export the check results as a file, right-click a data record, and choose Export Data from the
shortcut menu.
To restart a check task, right-click a historical task in the History Check Results area, and choose
Restart Task from the shortcut menu. The CME starts to check data based on the existing
settings.
The CME allows you to delete historical tasks in either of the following methods:
Select one or multiple tasks in the History Check Results, and click
Select a record from the check record list on the right of the History Check
Results area and click
Follow-up Procedure
After creating two or more data consistency check tasks, you can select two tasks in the
task navigation tree in the left pane of the check result window, right-click them, and
choose Compare Task Result from the shortcut menu to compare check results.
NOTE:
You can also compare the check results of two tasks in the following method:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
a.
Right-click a task and choose Choose to compare on left window from the
shortcut menu.
b.
Right-click the other task, and choose Compare to name of last task from the
shortcut menu.
463
7 Preparing Data
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
464
465
Step 4 In the displayed Set Maintenance Mode dialog box, select a target base station and set the
engineering mode.
If BTS3900 is selected from the NE navigation tree, the maintenance mode of the physical
NE BTS3900, logical GBTS, and logical NodeB must be set.
If eNodeBFunction, NodeBFunction, or GbtsFunction is selected from the NE navigation
tree, maintenance mode of the Function and its corresponding base station must be set.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
466
----End
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
467
9 Adjusting Hardware
Adjusting Hardware
Adjusting hardware may affect services. For details, see section 3.1.2 "General Impacts" in
3900 Series Multimode Base Station V100R010C10 Mode Transition Guide.
Adjusting BBUs
For details about BBU installation, see the installation guide of the corresponding base
station. For details about board installation, see the hardware maintenance guides of the
corresponding base station.
In the co-MPT reconstruction involving mode expansion scenario for UO, LO, UL, or some
hybrid-MPT base stations, convert the replaced WMPT or LMPT.
If the UMPTe serves as the main control board for the co-MPT base station after
reconstruction, the main control boards (including WMPT and LMPT) before reconstruction
are abandoned and removed from the subrack, and the main control board (UMPTa/b) before
reconstruction is retained and serves as the signaling extension board for the UMPTe.
Adjusting RF Modules
For details about how to install RRUs, see the related RRU installation guide.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
468
9 Adjusting Hardware
Adjusting Feeders
Connect feeders to the newly added MRRUs.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
469
10
Activating Configuration
Data and Commissioning
For details about the remote commissioning and USB flash drive-based commissioning, see 3900 Series
Base Station Commissioning Guide.
The LTE data configuration must be activated before the GSM and UMTS data configuration
because GUL co-transmission is implemented through the backplane and transmission ports
are provided on the LTE side after mode transition. Connect the transmission cable on the
GSM side to the LTE side and then activate the UMTS and GSM data configuration
successively if only one transmission cable is used. If two transmission cables are used,
connect the unused cable to the LTE side and then activate the UMTS and GSM data
configuration successively. There is no requirement on whether the other transmission cable
connected to the GSM side must be disconnected or not.
When you adjust the data of the original mode or when the data of the new mode includes
controller data, you must export an incremental script and use the script executor to activate
the script. For the operation methods, see 10.1 Activating Data in Incremental Scripts.
For the newly added mode to the co-MPT multimode base station, the remote U2000-based
commissioning without auxiliary equipment is recommended. For the operation methods, see
10.2 Base Station Deployment by PnP.
For the newly added mode to the separate-MPT multimode base station, either the remote
U2000-based commissioning without auxiliary equipment or the local USB + remote U2000based commissioning can be used. For the operation methods, see 10.2 Base Station
Deployment by PnP and 10.3 Base Station Deployment by USB.
For the newly added mode to the co-MPT reconstruction and capacity expansion, if the main
control board of the co-MPT base station is WMPT or LMPT, replace the WMPT or LMPT
with UMPT. The local USB + remote U2000-based commissioning can be used. If the main
control board of the co-MPT base station is UMPT, the remote U2000-based commissioning
can be used. For the operation methods, see 10.4 PnP-based Co-MPT Reconstruction and 10.3
Base Station Deployment by USB.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
470
Perform the operation described in Exporting Incremental Scripts in the Planned Data
Area.
Step 1 On the menu bar of the planned data area, choose Area Management > Planned Area >
Export Incremental Scripts (CME client mode) or CME > Planned Area > Export
Incremental Scripts (U2000 client mode). A dialog box is displayed for you to export
scripts.
If NE data in the planned data area has been modified, the CME automatically adds the
related NEs to the right pane.
If data in the planned data area is not modified, the CME displays a message indicating
that incremental scripts cannot be generated.
Break on Failure: The export stops immediately if an error occurs during the command
Best Effort: The CME continues with the export by running a command next to the
No: The exported scripts do not have encryption passwords and no encryption passwords
Yes: The exported scripts have encryption passwords. When loading projects, you have
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
471
a.
Select Yes.
b.
Click Set Password. In the displayed dialog box, enter the encryption password as
required.
The password must contain 6 to 32 characters.
c.
Click OK.
The exported encrypted script files are in .ecf format.
Then...
After the scripts are exported, you can click the save path link to navigate to the folder for
saving the scripts.
You need to manually start the script executor to activate incremental scripts in the future.
For detailed operations, see the manual startup process in Activating Data Using the Script
Executor.
Click OK. The CME then automatically uploads the exported scripts to the U2000 server. In
addition, the CME automatically switches to the Summary tab page of the script executor
and selects the planned data area node to which the new script project belongs.
In the list in the right pane of the planned data area, select the latest script project (based on
the creation time). You can check or edit scripts in the list and need to manually activate the
scripts in the future. For detailed operations, see the automatic startup process in Activating
Data Using the Script Executor.
NOTICE:
Before performing this operation, ensure that you have the network device permission Modify
Physical NE Data through CME. Otherwise, the scripts cannot be exported. For details about the
permission, see Introduction to Authority Management.
You need to directly 1. Select Launch script executor and activate exported project.
activate scripts
2. Select a script activation mode from the drop-down list.
Break on failure: If any error occurs when the scripts are being activated, the CME
immediately stops the activation. Commands that are executed before the error occurs
can be executed successfully.
Best effort: If any errors occur when the scripts are being activated, the CME skips the
error commands and proceeds with the activation. Commands other than the error
commands can be executed successfully.
For XML scripts, the CME performs operations based on the predefined mode, regardless of
your selection. Processing method: If an error occurs during the activation, the CME
immediately stops the activation and restores configuration data to the status before the
activation.
After scripts are exported, the CME automatically starts the script executor to activate
the scripts.
NOTICE:
Before performing this operation, ensure that you have the network device permission Modify
Physical NE Data through CME. Otherwise, the scripts cannot be exported. For details about the
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
472
If...
Then...
permission, see Introduction to Authority Management.
If Yes is displayed in the Is Fallback column, you have changed the NE cipher key from the
default value to another value and the NE cipher key in the fallback script is replaced with the
default value.
If No is displayed in the Is Fallback column, you have changed the NE cipher key from another
value to the default value and the NE cipher key in the positive script is replaced with the default
value.
Prerequisites
You have performed a conflict check to ensure that the activation can take effect.
You have the network device permission Modify Physical NE Data through CME. For details about
the permission, see Introduction to Authority Management.
Context
For details about the script executor, see CME Script Executor.
Figure 1 shows the process of activating the data in the configuration scripts by using the
script executor.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
473
NOTE:
You can choose to manually start the script executor or enable automatic startup based on site
requirements. The startup methods are described as follows:
Manually starting the script executor: Manually start the script executor and upload the scripts saved
on the local PC to the U2000 server.
Enabling automatic startup of the script executor: During the generation of scripts in the
configuration wizard, select Launch the script executor. The CME then automatically imports
and uploads the scripts.
Description
Upload scripts Upload the configuration scripts to the U2000 server. For detailed operations, see Uploading
Scripts.
This operation is required only when you manually start the script executor.
Check or edit
scripts
You can check the content of uploaded scripts on the GUI. To adjust some parameters in an
uploaded script, edit them in the script executor directly. For detailed operations, see Checking or
Editing Scripts.
NOTE:
After you modify parameters in the script executor, the CME does not verify the data. Ensure that the
parameters are correctly modified.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
474
Description
If multiple parameters are to be modified, you are advised to reconfigure parameters in the planned data
area, export a script, and then re-upload the script.
Activate data
Activate data in the uploaded configuration scripts. For detailed operations, see Activating Data.
Fallback based
on the
configuration
steps
After configuration data takes effect on the live network, the network KPIs, however, do not meet
related requirements after being detected. In such a case, you can use the script executor to
activate a fallback script to fall back the configuration data to a state before the modification. For
detailed operations, see Fallback Based on Configuration Steps.
View
activation
tasks
Manage projects and tasks, such as viewing task information and status. For detailed operations,
see Viewing Activation Tasks.
Export
configuration
scripts in a
project
Export configuration scripts by NE from the U2000 server to a local PC to exchange with other
users. For detailed operations, see Exporting Configuration Scripts in a Project.
----End
Exporting Files Related to Base Station Creation/RAT Introduction to Co-MPT Base Stations
Step 1 On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Export Auto Deployment Data (CME client mode)
or CME > Advanced > Export Auto Deployment Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box
is displayed for you to export auto-deployment data.
Step 2 Select Site creation/expansion scenario, and click Next.
Step 3 Select the base stations whose auto-deployment data you want to export, and click Next.
NOTE:
You can click Load to select base stations to be exported by loading a file. The method of obtaining the
file and the file format rules are described as follows:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
475
Obtaining the file: Click Export. The CME then exports the file. You have to set values for the
parameters in the exported file.
File format rules: For details, see File Format Rules.
If the check boxes and buttons are unavailable, you can only view information in the dialog box.
Step 4 Select a save path for the exported file and a method for processing data, and click Next.
If...
Then...
Export data
from the
current area
After Export NE security configuration data is selected, if the current user has the Obtain
NE Security Configuration Data operation rights, NE sensitive data is displayed in plaintext
in the exported data file; if the current user does not have the Obtain NE Security
Configuration Data operation rights, a message is displayed on the CME, indicating that
sensitive data cannot be exported. For details about the operating rights, see Introduction to
Authority Management.
Export data
from the
planned area
Step 5 View data in the base station deployment list, and click Next. The CME starts to verify data
correctness and exports the data.
NOTE:
If the parameter values displayed on the GUI are different from planned values, you need to change the
parameter values based on the planned values. Otherwise, the deployment may fail.
You can only set the first level subnet information. To specify subnets at other levels, adjust the subnet
information in the U2000 topology view after base station commissioning.
If the user-specified subnet information does not exist on the U2000, the U2000 automatically generates
the subnet during the import of auto-deployment data in the commissioning.
When editing data, you can use Ctrl+C and Ctrl+V to copy information from one cell to multiple
cells.
Step 6 If the export is successful in U2000 client mode, set the following options:
Select Do not open the Auto Deployment window to close the wizard.
Select Open the Auto Deployment window. The CME automatically switches to the
auto-deployment window and creates a commissioning task.
Select Open the Auto Deployment window and start Auto Deployment task . The
CME automatically switches to the auto-deployment window and starts a commissioning
task.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
476
Procedure
Step 1 On the U2000 client, choose SON > Self Planning > Auto Deployment (application style) or
SON > Auto Deployment (traditional style). The Auto Deployment window is displayed.
Step 2 Start the NE commissioning task, as shown in the following figure.
Figure 1.1 Starting an NE commissioning task
a.
Select one or multiple commission tasks and right-click these commissioning tasks.
Click Start. The Task Parameter Settings window is displayed.
If global parameters have been set before the start of a commissioning task, parameters in the Task
Parameter Settings dialog box use the global parameter settings. Engineers can modify the parameter
settings based on the actual data plan. Global parameters can be set as follows: Right-click the
commissioning task list area and choose Global Parameter Settings.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
477
For details about the U2000-based commissioning process for a newly deployed base
station, see Table 1.1.
Table 1.1 U2000-based commissioning process for a newly deployed base station
No.
Phase
Procedure
Selection Policy
Check OM channel
Auto configure
site
Download software
Download site
configuration
Activate site
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Deliver license
Deliver commissioning
license
No.
Phase
Procedure
Selection Policy
commissioned.
Monitor RF module
service status
Intervene
Waiting for
confirmation
pp.
Waiting for
confirmation
qq.
Click OK.
Tip 3: After the start of an NE commissioning task is confirmed, the U2000 checks
the required data configuration file:
If the data configuration file is available, the U2000 starts commissioning and the
corresponding task is in the Running state.
----End
Procedure
Step 1 Obtain the software package from Huawei engineers and decompressed the software package
on a local PC.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
479
If the preconfigured software of the main control board of the base station to be deployed is
SRAN8.0 or later, obtain the software package "BTS3900
V100R011C00SPCXXX_ALL(Software)support from SRAN8.0 and later Versions.7z." If the NE
type of an NE to be deployed is BTS3900 and a GTMUb serves as the main control board, you also
need to obtain the software package BTS3900V900R011C00SPCXXX.zip for implementing the
GTMUb SingleOM reconstruction.
If the preconfigured software of the main control board of the base station to be deployed is earlier
than SRAN8.0 or unknown, obtain the software package "BTS3900
V100R011C00SPCXXX_ALL(Software).7z."
Option
Description
GBTS
Step 2 Export a deployment list and data configuration files from the Configuration Management
Express (CME). For details, see Exporting Deployment Lists and Data Configuration Files
from the CME.
After the deployment list and data configuration files are exported from the CME, choose Do
not open the Auto Deployment window.
Data configuration files and deployment lists exported from the CME are saved in the
following paths. Do not modify any exported files or the directory structure of any exported
files.
Do not copy the .xml files from a remote desktop to a local PC. Otherwise, base station
deployment will fail. You are advised to compress the required files into a .rar or .zip file
for file transfer.
Step 3 Save the data configuration files on the local PC. Then, perform the following steps to upload
the deployment list to the U2000 server.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
a.
On the U2000 client, choose SON > Self Planning > Auto Deployment
(Application style) or SON > Auto Deployment (Traditional style). The Auto
Deployment window is displayed.
rr.
Click the Prepare File & Data tab and then the Deployment List tab.
480
Figure 1.1 Prepare File & Data > Deployment List tab
ss.
Click Transfer, and choose From OSS Client to OSS Server from the shortcut
menu. The Upload Deployment List dialog box is displayed.
The File Path in the Destination Path area shows the file save path on the server. This path cannot be
modified.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
481
tt.
Click
in the Source Path area. The Open dialog box is displayed. Select
the deployment list (.xml) to be uploaded, and click Open. The Upload
Deployment List dialog box is displayed.
uu.
Click OK. The Upload Deployment List dialog box is closed, and the upload
starts.
The File Transfer Task tab page at the bottom of the Auto Deployment dialog box
displays detailed operation information, including Operation, Status, Object,
Progress, Start Time, End Time, and Information. When Progress is 100%, the
upload is complete.
Procedure
Step 1 Choose Start > Programs > iManager U2000 MBB Client > USB Making and Protection Tool
to start the tool.
Figure 1.1 USB making and protection tool
Step 2 Choose Make USB > Path Settings. The Path Settings dialog box is displayed, as shown in
the following figure.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
482
Step 3 Set the local save paths for the software and files, NE type, and working mode based on the
types of USB flash drive directories. Then click OK.
When making different types of directories on a USB flash drive, specify items listed in the
Information to Set column only and do not set items that are not listed in this column.
You need to set the NE Type and Service Mode parameter only when the USB flash drive directory of
software is to be upgraded.
Item
Information to Set
Directory for
upgrading the
software and
updating
configuration
files
Cold Patch Path: optional, save path of the files decompressed from
a specified cold patch package.
Hot Patch Path: optional, save path of the files decompressed from a
specified hot patch package.
483
Item
Information to Set
Auto Deployment List: mandatory. Select the deployment list exported
from the CME.
The exported deployment list is saved in export path/ADList/ by
default. Engineers must select the only .xml file in this directory.
NodeB/eNodeB/BTS3900 Precfg file: recommended. Select the
created Precfg.ini file.
If Precfg.ini is not selected, base station software is downloaded based
on the latest configurations that take effect. After the software and data
configuration files are loaded from the USB flash drive and the base
station is restarted, the software version of the newly added board will
be automatically added. If Precfg.ini is selected, the base station
downloads the software based on the board type specified in the
Precfg.ini file.
LTE Commissioning License: mandatory if LTE services are to be
enabled. Select the LTE commissioning license you have obtained.
Do not copy .csp file: this item is selected by default. If the prepared
directories need to be delivered to other engineers, select this item. In
this case, all files and integrity protection information except the .csp
files are saved in the directories and you can send them through emails.
Copy these files to the USB flash drive containing the intact software
package. Use this USB flash drive to upgrade the software and update
configuration files.
NOTE
The Do not copy .csp file item is not configured for the USB making and
protection tool of earlier versions. After the USB directories are prepared, you
need to manually delete the software directories MBTS\Software,
eNodeB\Software, and NodeB\Software to deliver the USB directories. Then,
copy these USB directories to the USB flash drive containing the intact software
package. Use this USB flash drive to upgrade the software and update
configuration files.
Directory for
updating
configuration
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
484
Item
Information to Set
files only
default. Engineers must select the only .xml file in this directory.
LTE Commissioning License: mandatory if LTE services are to be
enabled. Select the LTE commissioning license you have obtained.
Directory for
upgrading the
software only
Cold Patch Path: optional, save path of the files decompressed from
a specified cold patch package.
Hot Patch Path: optional, save path of the files decompressed from a
specified hot patch package.
Step 4 The USB making and protection tool automatically parses the information of the target NE
and displays the information on the USB Making and Protection Tool interface. Select the
NE that requires a USB flash drive. After all NE information is correctly specified, select a
deployment mode in the USB Flash Drive Type area.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
485
If the specified software package is a package for a single mode, you can only select NEs of this mode
when making a USB flash drive.
Option
Description
Step 5 In the Protection Mechanism area, select an encryption algorithm from the Encryption
Algorithm drop-down list and select an integrity protection algorithm from the Integrity
Algorithm drop-down list.
Description
Local Path
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
486
Option
Description
specified directory. The software
package is shared by all NEs and the
data configuration files are distinguished
by ESN-named directories.
The existing data configuration files may be damaged when being copied, encrypted, or integrity
protected. To prevent any damages, USB Flash Drive Path and Local Path must not contain any files
or directories.
Applies integrity protection and encryption protection to files under the USB directories according
to manual settings.
Copies the configuration files to the USB directories of corresponding NEs according to the saving
path of configuration files in the deployment list.
Copies all files under the directory specified by Software Path to the USB directories of
corresponding NEs according to the directory structure of the USB flash drive.
Step 8 Click OK in the dialog box displayed after the tool completes the making of the USB flash
drive.
Step 9 Optional: If Output Path is set to Local Path, copy the files to the USB flash drive. If Local
Path is set to Computer/DataCenter(D:)/USB File in Step 6.
One USB for one site: Choose Computer >DataCenter(D:) > USB File, as shown in
Figure 1.1. If the NE to be deployed is site 1, copy the MBTS, NodeB, and eNodeB
folders from the Site1 folder to the USB flash drive.
One USB for multiple sites: Choose Computer > DataCenter(D:) > USB File, as
shown in Figure 1.2. Copy the MBTS, NodeB, and eNodeB folders from the USB File
folder to the USB flash drive.
If you have not selected Support xMPT with SRAN7.0 in Path Settings, the MBTS
directory is generated. If you have selected Support xMPT with SRAN7.0 in Path Settings,
the generated directory has the following file folders: MBTS, NodeB, and eNodeB. Folders
NodeB and eNodeB are used for an upgrade of a main control board from SRAN7.0 or earlier
to SRAN10.0.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
487
After a file is copied from a computer to a USB flash drive, the file may change due to
faults on hardware or the Window OS, but this seldom occurs. In this case, you can copy
the file from another computer, to another USB flash drive, or restart the OS and copy the
file again.
After the folders are copied to the USB flash drive, eject or safely remove the USB flash
drive from the Windows operating system. You can only remove the USB flash drive from
the PC after either of the preceding operations. If the USB flash drive is forcibly ejected,
the files in the USB flash drive may be damaged. As a result, software and data
configuration files cannot be loaded by using the USB flash drive.
When transferring files for a making USB flash drive, do not copy the .xml files from a
remote desktop to a local PC. Otherwise, base station deployment will fail. You are
advised to compress the required files into a .rar or .zip file for file transfer.
You can use file comparison software, such as the BCCompare, to compare whether the file copied to
the USB flash drive is consistent with that on the computer.
Figure 1.1 File copy procedure in One USB for One Site mode
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
488
Figure 1.2 File copy procedure in One USB for Multiple Sites mode
When the base station with a GTMUb serving as the main control board is reconstructed for supporting
SingleOM, the BTS3900 GSM directory is generated. You need to copy this directory to the USB flash
drive.
Procedure
Step 1 Save the required files in the specified paths on the USB flash drive.
Files required in different scenarios are listed in Error: Reference source not found. Save
paths for different types of files on a USB flash drive are listed in Table 1.1. The directory
structure on a USB flash drive is shown in Figure 1.2.
The name of the save path for TranCfg.INI cannot contain Chinese characters or double-byte
characters. Otherwise, the deployment fails.
Table 1.1 Save paths for different types of files on a USB flash drive
File
Save Path
Software package
Pre-configuration script
(Precfg.ini)
usb:\BTS3900 GSM\Precfg.ini
Transmission configuration
files (Trancfg.INI) and
transmission mode
configuration file
(TranModeCfg.ini)
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
For TranCfg.INI:
489
File
Save Path
Step 2 For details about how to perform integrity protection and encryption on the files stored on a
USB flash drive, see Error: Reference source not foundError: Reference source not found or
Error: Reference source not foundError: Reference source not found.
Use the USB making and protection tool to make a USB flash drive.
Step 1 Choose Start > Programs > iManager U2000 MBB Client > USB Making and Protection Tool
to start the tool.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
490
Step 2 Choose Make USB > Path Settings. The Path Settings dialog box is displayed, as shown in
the following figure.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
491
Step 3 Set save paths for the deployment list, pre-configuration script (Precfg.ini), and transmission
mode configuration file (TranModeCfg.ini). Then click OK.
When making different types of directories on a USB flash drive, specify items listed in the
Information to Set column only and do not set items that are not listed in this column.
You need to set the NE Type and Service Mode parameter only when the USB flash drive directory of
software is to be upgraded.
Item
Information to Set
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
492
Item
Information to Set
configuration files are used. The deployment list is saved
under Exported directory/ADList/ when exported from the
CME. The operation personnel can only select the unique
.xml file under this directory, and the tool automatically
copies the TranCfg.INI file to the specified directory.
GBTS transmission mode configuration file
(TranModeCfg.ini): Select this file when transmission mode
configuration files are used. When selecting such a file, find
the file, and the tool automatically copies TranModeCfg.ini to
the specified directory.
Do not copy .csp file: Software Path is not set, and
therefore Do not copy .csp file does not take effect regardless
of whether it is selected or not.
Support xMPT with SRAN7.0: This parameter does not take
effect regardless of whether it is selected or not.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
493
Step 4 The USB making and protection tool automatically parses the information of the target NE
and displays the information on the USB Making and Protection Tool interface. Select the
NE that requires a USB flash drive. After all NE information is correctly specified, select a
deployment mode in the USB Flash Drive Type area.
Item
Description
Step 5 In the Protection Mechanism area, select an encryption algorithm from the Encryption
Algorithm drop-down list and select an integrity protection algorithm from the Integrity
Algorithm drop-down list.
Description
Local Path
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
494
Item
Description
folder.
The existing data configuration files may be damaged when being copied, encrypted, or integrity
protected. To prevent any damages, USB Flash Drive Path and Local Path must not contain any files
or directories.
Applies integrity protection and encryption protection to files under the USB directories according
to manual settings.
Copies the configuration files to the USB directories of corresponding NEs according to the saving
path of configuration files in the deployment list.
Step 8 Click OK in the dialog box displayed after the tool completes the making of the USB flash
drive.
Step 9 If the Local Path option is selected in the Output Path area, copy the files to the USB flash
drive. In the save path specified by Local Path in 99, select the folders of the NEs to be
deployed and copy the folders to the USB flash drive.
After a file is copied from a computer to a USB flash drive, the file may change due to
faults on hardware or the Window OS, but this seldom occurs. In this case, you can copy
the file from another computer, to another USB flash drive, or restart the OS and copy the
file again.
After the folders are copied to the USB flash drive, eject or safely remove the USB flash
drive from the Windows operating system. You can only remove the USB flash drive from
the PC after either of the preceding operations. If the USB flash drive is forcibly ejected,
the files in the USB flash drive may be damaged. As a result, software and data
configuration files cannot be loaded by using the USB flash drive.
When transferring files for a making USB flash drive, do not copy the .xml files from a
remote desktop to a local PC. Otherwise, base station deployment will fail. You are
advised to compress the required files into a .rar or .zip file for file transfer.
You can use file comparison software, such as the BCCompare, to compare whether the file copied to
the USB flash drive is consistent with that on the computer.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
495
Step 10 Open the BTS3900 GSM directory on a USB flash drive, decompress the software package of
the target version-BTS3900 V100RXXXCXXSPCXXX_GBTS(Tools).zip file, and copy
the .csp file for upgrading the GBTS using a USB flash drive to this directory.
Figure 1.1 File copy procedure for GBTS commissioning
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
496
Procedure
Step 1 On the U2000 client, choose SON > Self Planning > Auto Deployment (application style) or
SON > Auto Deployment (traditional style). The Auto Deployment window is displayed.
Step 2 Start the NE commissioning task, as shown in the following figure.
Figure 1.1 Starting an NE commissioning task
----End
Step 1 Select one or multiple commission tasks and right-click these commissioning tasks. Click
Start. The Task Parameter Settings window is displayed.
If global parameters have been set before the start of a commissioning task, parameters in the Task
Parameter Settings dialog box use the global parameter settings. Engineers can modify the parameter
settings based on the actual data plan. Global parameters can be set as follows: Right-click the
commissioning task list area and choose Global Parameter Settings.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
497
For details about the USB+U2000-based commissioning process for a newly deployed
base station, see Table 1.1.
Table 1.1 USB+U2000-based commissioning process for a newly deployed base station
No.
Phase
Procedure
Selection Policy
Check OM channel
Auto configure
site
Download site
configuration
Activate site
Deliver license
Deliver commissioning
license
Monitor RF module
service status
Intervene
Waiting for
confirmation
Waiting for
confirmation
498
Tip 2: Extended Parameters defines threshold parameters for commissioning the antenna
system in the Test installation & deployment quality phase. If there are no special
requirements, default values of these parameters are used. If there are special requirements,
set these parameters as required.
Step 4 Click OK.
Tip 3: After the start of an NE commissioning task is confirmed, the U2000 checks the
required data configuration file:
If the data configuration file is available, the U2000 starts commissioning and the
corresponding task is in the Running state.
----End
Exporting Files Related to Base Station Creation/RAT Introduction to Co-MPT Base Stations
Step 1 On the menu bar, choose Advanced > Export Auto Deployment Data (CME client mode)
or CME > Advanced > Export Auto Deployment Data (U2000 client mode). A dialog box
is displayed for you to export auto-deployment data.
Step 2 Select Site creation/expansion scenario, and click Next.
Step 3 Select the base stations whose auto-deployment data you want to export, and click Next.
NOTE:
You can click Load to select base stations to be exported by loading a file. The method of obtaining the
file and the file format rules are described as follows:
Obtaining the file: Click Export. The CME then exports the file. You have to set values for the
parameters in the exported file.
File format rules: For details, see File Format Rules.
If the check boxes and buttons are unavailable, you can only view information in the dialog box.
Step 4 Select a save path for the exported file and a method for processing data, and click Next.
If...
Then...
Export data
from the
current area
After Export NE security configuration data is selected, if the current user has the Obtain
NE Security Configuration Data operation rights, NE sensitive data is displayed in plaintext
in the exported data file; if the current user does not have the Obtain NE Security
Configuration Data operation rights, a message is displayed on the CME, indicating that
sensitive data cannot be exported. For details about the operating rights, see Introduction to
Authority Management.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
499
If...
Then...
ciphertext in the exported data file.
Export data
from the
planned area
Step 5 View data in the base station deployment list, and click Next. The CME starts to verify data
correctness and exports the data.
NOTE:
If the parameter values displayed on the GUI are different from planned values, you need to change the
parameter values based on the planned values. Otherwise, the deployment may fail.
You can only set the first level subnet information. To specify subnets at other levels, adjust the subnet
information in the U2000 topology view after base station commissioning.
If the user-specified subnet information does not exist on the U2000, the U2000 automatically generates
the subnet during the import of auto-deployment data in the commissioning.
When editing data, you can use Ctrl+C and Ctrl+V to copy information from one cell to multiple
cells.
Step 6 If the export is successful in U2000 client mode, set the following options:
Select Do not open the Auto Deployment window to close the wizard.
Select Open the Auto Deployment window. The CME automatically switches to the
auto-deployment window and creates a commissioning task.
Select Open the Auto Deployment window and start Auto Deployment task . The
CME automatically switches to the auto-deployment window and starts a commissioning
task.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
a.
On the U2000, choose SON > Auto Deployment. On the Deployment List tab
page, right-click a site and choose Import Deployment List to import the
deployment list generated during data conversion.
vv.
On the Site Configuration Data tab page, upload data configurations of a co-MPT
site generated after site reconstruction to the U2000.
ww.
500
On the Software&Cold Patch tab page, upload GTMU conversion software and
co-MPT software to the U2000 if required based on site reconstruction
requirements.
xx.
To upload the GTMU conversion software, set NE type to GBTS. To upload the co-MPT
software, set NE type to BTS3900.
Step 2 Download the GTMU conversion software and co-MPT software.
During PnP task settings, site software needs to be loaded beforehand to reduce the
time for software loading at night. For batch reconstruction of multiple sites, finish
data configuration in the Task Parameter Settings dialog box for each site
beforehand. Details are as follows:
a.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
501
yy.
After this task is executed, the status of the task will be Waiting for Confirmation. In this
case, do not confirm it. Then, you can repeat the task subsequently. If you confirm it, you
have to create another PnP task later.
Step 3 Restart the site reconstruction task. Specifically, execute reconstruction scripts (when a base
station controller is involved), and download and activate the configuration file.
a.
In BSC node redundancy scenarios, perform the PnP tasks on the master and slave BSCs at the same
time.
Finish data configuration in the Task Parameter Settings dialog box before
reconstruction. Specifically, select Download BSC configuration data, Query GBTS
license information, Deliver license, Download site software, Download site
configuration, and Activate site. Then click Restart to start the batch reconstruction.
For the reconstruction scenarios of GU+L/GL+U with BBUs interconnected, select Change
the peer main control board to co-MPT to ensure that BBU 1 works as the secondary BBU
after reconstruction; or select Activate GTMU evolution software when the preceding steps
are performed for a co-MPT base station using the UMPT after reconstruction.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
502
zz.
aaa.
Ensure a reachable route between the U2000 and IP address of the base station after
reconstruction before clicking Confirm Completion. In this way, licenses can be successfully
delivered, and the PnP task will be complete.
Step 4 Adjust data of intermediate devices.
This step is required only when co-transmission is not used before reconstruction and GSM uses the IP
over FE transmission.
a.
bbb.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
503
On the U2000, synchronize configurations, and the eGBTS that is newly deployed on the
BSC will be displayed.
On the eGBTS licensed-resource allocation page of the U2000, choose a BSC, rightclick the newly deployed eGBTS, and choose Modify. In the displayed window, set
UMPT Multi Mode License(GSM) (per UMPT) to 1, and click OK.
On the licensed-resource allocation page, right-click the eGBTS and choose Allocate
Remaining Resources to BSC. The licensed value of the GBTS (BSC) is automatically
modified.
a.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Right-click the target base station and choose Properties. In the displayed NE
Properties dialog box, check whether the value of NE Type is BTS3900.
504
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
505
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Check whether the modes deployed on the target base station are displayed, as
shown in the following figure.
Right-click the target base station and choose Device Maintenance to check
whether the mode information about each board is correct, as shown in the
following figures. Note that the UMPT serves multiple modes, the WBBP serves
the UMTS mode, the LBBP serves the LTE mode, and the
UBRI/UTRP/FAN/UCIU/UEIU/UPEU/PSU/TCU serves multiple modes.
506
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
507
mode from the U2000 MBTS topology. After the base station is removed, its
historical alarms and traffic statistics are all deleted and you cannot query them.
The status of the base station deployed with the non-reference mode is
unavailable. Delete such a base station as follows:
Select the name of the base station to be deleted on the topology.
ccc.
Check whether services of each mode are processed properly after reconstruction.
ddd.
Check whether new alarms are generated after co-MPT reconstruction. If new
alarms are generated, clear them.
eee.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
508
Check whether the values of service KPIs specific to each mode are normal and
whether these values unexpectedly fluctuate after co-MPT reconstruction.
For measurement items registered on the U2000 before reconstruction, you need to register
measurement items for the co-MPT base station because the NE type has changed to
BTS3900.
Step 8 Adjust the DHCP server.
The DHCP server must be deployed on the U2000 after the reconstruction. If the DHCP
server is deployed on the BSC before the reconstruction, you need to switch it from the BSC
to the U2000. If the DHCP server is deployed on the U2000 before the reconstruction, skip
this step.
----End
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
509
11
Restore the maintenance mode for the base station when it is operating properly after the
commissioning.
You may restore the maintenance mode by NE or by mode, which must be consistent with the
granularity when you set the maintenance mode. Use the same way to set the maintenance
mode to Normal.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
510
12
Paths for saving the deployment list and configuration data of a separate-MPT base
station
2.
<OUT_PUTDIR>\BakData\ AutoDeployment_***\AdList\
Auto_Deployment_List_***.xml
<OUT_PUTDIR>\BakData\AutoDeployment_***\CfgData\<site
name>\***.xml
3.
Path for saving the project file which is used to creat a rollback task and will be imported
to the CME executor
4.
<OUT_PUTDIR>\mml\<controller name>\Fallback\scriptcfg.xml
<OUT_PUTDIR>\mml\<BSC name>\Fallback\<site name>.txt
Path for saving the co-MPT data configuration file after reconstruction
<OUT_PUTDIR>\AutoDeploymentData\CfgData\<site name>\CFGDATA.XML
5.
6.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
511
When separate-MPT multimode base stations are reconstructed into one co-MPT base
station, the conversion tool consolidates the node MOs of the multiple modes to those for
the co-MPT base station. When configuration data differs with modes, the tool modifies
the configuration data for the modes involved based on the value of the
SRANBaselineRAT parameter in the data planning template. If this parameter is not
specified, the tool applies the configuration data used on the more advanced mode to the
other modes of the MBTS in question. For example, the tool applies the configuration
data used on the UMTS side to the GSM of a GU dual-mode base station. If this
parameter is specified, the tool applies the configuration data used on the specified mode
to the other modes of the MBTS in question.
If consolidated data affects the system, alarms will be generated and displayed in the
result area and conversion logs. You need to determine whether the data needs to be
adjusted based on actual network conditions.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
512
If a BSC uses a commissioning license or temporary commercial license, you cannot obtain
an eGBTS license file by splitting the license on the FNO. In this scenario, you need to apply
for a commissioning license or temporary commercial license for the eGBTS by using the
eGBTS license template at least one week in advance.
Note that Huawei now supports two license distribution platforms: FNO and ESDP. You can
apply for licenses on either of them. This document uses the FNO as an example to describe
license application.
GSM license preparation is required only when the first batch of base stations to be
reconstructed are all GBTSs.
Revoke the BSC license file on the BSC and obtain the revocation code.
a.
On the web LMT of the BSC6900/BSC6910 to which the eGBTS belongs, run the
LST LICENSE command to query the current license file, as shown in the
following figure.
b.
On the same web LMT, run the RVK LICENSE command. Then enter the name of
the license file to be revoked, as shown in the following figure.
Log in to the FNO on the website of license.huawei.com. Choose GTS Portal > Split
GSM License.
Enter the revocation code and click Search. Then the resources to be split are listed, as
shown in the following figure.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
513
Click Submit. The system will split a BSC license file into a new BSC license file and
an eGBTS license file.
After the task is complete, the FNO will send the results to your mailbox. If the task fails,
click Error Repair. If the error persists, contact the IT hotline or License Fulfillment
Department.
Click My Task and then download the license files. You can also download the license files
from your mailbox.
Only licensed resources for features supported by both eGBTSs and GBTSs and those
supported only by GBTSs can be split through the preceding steps. (License control items for
features supported only by GBTSs can be delivered by the U2000 to the BSC in order to
control the GBTSs. In this way, license files do not need to be replaced when the eGBTSs
support such features subsequently.) The UMPT Multi Mode License(GSM)(per UMPT)
supported by eGBTSs needs to be separately applied for, and is not required in GO co-MPT
reconstruction. Such license control items for eGBTSs as the IPSec bypass (per BTS), UMPT
Multi Mode License(GSM), Antenna Feeder Intermodulation Test (per TRX), and Spectrum
Scan (per TRX) must be applied for in other ways. For details, see GBSS18.1 eGBTS License
Application Guide.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
514
2.
On the FNO, choose GTS Portal > Manage Licenses > Manage Licenses.
3.
In the displayed window, choose ESN from the drop-down list of Search By. Enter an
ESN in the text box of Search For. Click
to query all the license files of this NE.
4.
Select the NE license files for the same product. Click Consolidate and the window
shown in the following figure will be displayed. Select the incorporated license files to
be downloaded and click Save to File to save these files on the local PC.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
515
The license control item "UMPT Multi Mode License(GSM)" must be applied for when
multimode base stations to be reconstructed serve GSM. In this scenario, the license
control item should be quoted first by sales, and then the GTS personnel apply for the
license control item. For more information, see steps 1 to 5 of section "Applying for a
License During Version Upgrade, Capacity Expansion, or New Feature Deployment" in
chapter "License Application Operations Guidance in Different Scenarios" in GBSS18.1
eGBTS License Application Guide. For the license control items "Antenna Feeder
Intermodulation Test (per TRX) and "Spectrum Scan (per TRX)", only a temporary
license can be applied for when a permanent commercial license or
permanent&temporary commercial license is used. For more information, see steps 1 to
4 of section "Applying for a Permanent&Temporary/Trial License" in chapter "License
Application Operations Guidance in Different Scenarios" in GBSS18.1 eGBTS License
Application Guide.
"IPSec bypass (per BTS)" is a customized license control item, and is usually not
required during the reconstruction. If it is required, the license control item should be
quoted first by sales, and then the GTS personnel apply for the license control item. For
more information, see steps 1 to 5 of section "Applying for a License During Version
Upgrade, Capacity Expansion, or New Feature Deployment" in chapter "License
Application Operations Guidance in Different Scenarios" in GBSS18.1 eGBTS License
Application Guide.
The steps above have covered the operations for obtaining the eGBTS license and
incorporating new license control items.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
516
When these two types of license files are used for reconstruction, all license control items for
an eGBTS (the license control item "UMPT Multi Mode License(GSM)" must be contained)
must be directly applied for instead of being obtained by splitting the BSC license file.
For details on how to apply for a temporary commercial license for the eGBTS, see section
"Applying for a License in Exceptional Cases" of chapter "License Application Operations
Guidance in Different Scenarios" in GBSS18.1 eGBTS License Application Guide.
For details on how to apply for a commissioning license for the eGBTS, see section
"Manually Applying for a Commissioning License" of chapter "License Application
Operations Guidance in Different Scenarios" in GBSS18.1 eGBTS License Application Guide.
The error indicates that the version of GTMU conversion software saved on the U2000 is
inconsistent with that in the auto-deployment list. First, check whether the parameter
ActBTSSoftwareVersion is specified in the data planning template and whether the value is
correct. If the parameter is not specified or the parameter value is incorrect, specify or correct
it and convert data again. If the parameter is correctly specified, check whether the GTMU
conversion software package has been uploaded to the U2000 and whether the version is
consistent with the specified one. If the software package has not been uploaded or the
package version is inconsistent with the specified one, upload the specified software package
and execute the PnP task again.
Replace the transmission and main control boards with those used before reconstruction
and insert the original boards to the corresponding slots.
Replace the baseband processing boards with those used before reconstruction and insert
the original boards to the corresponding slots. In addition, remove the newly added
baseband processing boards or UBRI boards.
Replace the RF modules with those used before reconstruction and insert the original
units to the corresponding boards. In addition, adjust the antenna system.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
517
2.
This operation is required when the GSM mode is involved in the reconstruction.
Upload scripts through the CME script executor. Specifically, select the directory where the
rollback scripts described in 3 are saved to import the BSC rollback scripts. Then execute the
rollback scripts to roll back BSC data configuration.
3.
Create the same separate-MPT NEs as those before reconstruction through the Auto
Deployment function.
4.
When GSM is involved in reconstruction and the GTMU is converted, a power-off reset is
required on the GTMU for rollback to prevent the GTMU from exceptions after the GTMU
software version is rolled back and the GTMU works as a main control unit again.
Perform this operation once the NodeB/eNodeB is normal. You can run the following
command to power off the GTMU: RST BRDPWROFF:CN=0,SRN=0,SN=6;
5.
Change the NodeB's OMCH IP address configured on an RNC to the OMCH IP address of the
NodeB before the reconstruction for rollback in the following reconstruction scenarios: UL
site reconstruction (LTE is deployed as the reference mode), GL+U site reconstruction, and
two BBUs are consolidated (including UMTS and LTE, with LTE as the reference mode).
Run the LST OMCH command to query the OMCH IP address of the NodeB.
Run the MOD UNODEBIP command to change the NodeB's OMCH IP address
configured on the RNC to the OMCH IP address of the NodeB before reconstruction.
The following is a command example: MOD UNODEBIP: IDTYPE=BYID,
NODEBID=1, NBTRANTP=IPTRANS_IP, NBIPOAMIP="10.171.35.123",
NBIPOAMMASK="255.255.255.0", IPSRN=0, IPSN=18, IPLOGPORTFLAG=NO;
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
After the standalone CME is used to prepare co-MPT configuration data in offline mode,
the cabinet No., subrack No., and slot No. of the main control board cannot be adjusted
and the main control board cannot be removed after the co-MPT reconstruction during
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
518
the device reconstruction on the standalone CME. In the co-MPT reconstruction scenario
where the GSM mode is included, after the co-MPT reconstruction, you cannot change
the GTMU handling method when performing other reconstruction activities in offline
mode. If you change the GTMU handling method, the deployment list exported by the
standalone CME after configuration data is prepared will be abnormal. For example,
GTMU evolution is adopted during co-MPT reconstruction, but the GTMU is abandoned
during device reconstruction.
2.
The configuration data of the GBTS can be converted only in By ID mode by using the
standalone CME. To set the By ID mode, select By ID in the GSM Script Index Type
Options dialog box.
Limitation on NE Equipment
1.
Data of only the following GSM base stations can be converted: DBS3900 (GSM),
BTS3900 (GSM), BTS3900A (GSM), BTS3900L (GSM), and BTS3900AL (GSM).
2.
3.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
519
4.
The conversion is not performed if the parameter Send Mode of a GBTS is set to a value
other than NOCOMB(No Combination) or DTIC(Transmit Independency or
Combination).
5.
Omit the following functions when performing conversion if any of them are enabled for
a GBTS: inter-module RF frequency hopping or inter-module power sharing, and interPA RF frequency hopping or inter-PA power sharing.
6.
Reconstruction cannot be performed if two sectors with different modes share a part of
the antenna before reconstruction, or if two baseband devices with different modes share
the same part of baseband processing units before reconstruction.
7.
8.
The GTMUa boards for the GSM sites can only fall into disuse and cannot be converted
after the reconstruction.
9.
If the replaced LMPT and WMPT boards are used as main control boards in other sites,
the IP configuration data retained in the boards may conflict with that of other sites. In
this scenario, you need to download the data configuration using the USB or LMT before
connecting them to the transmission network.
10. Only one user can convert the GBTSs under the same BSC for one time.
11. In the BSC node redundancy scenarios, the scenario where the GBTSs can be
reconstructed to eGBTSs only after the BSC switchover is not considered.
12. When the GBTS includes RFU and RRU and the RRUs are connected to the UBRI and
RFU to the GTMU through the CPRI cables, the GBTS is reconstructed into the eGBTS
through GTMU evolution. This is because a new UBRI is required if the GTMU is
abandoned, and the Multi-site Cell feature for GBTS does not support co-cell between
two transmission boards.
13. The separate-MPT base stations configured with BBU3910 can be reconstructed to coMPT base stations. Hardware configuration (subrack quantity, subrack type, subrack
number, board quantity, board type, and slot number) remains unchanged after the
reconstruction.
14. The BBU3910A has only one main control unit, and therefore it supports multiple modes
implemented only by the co-MPT. In this case, it involves the UO/LO co-MPT
reconstruction only. If the BBU3910A needs to support multimode co-MPT, it is
recommended that a new multimode co-MPT base station be deployed or modes be
added to the main control board after single-mode co-MPT reconstruction. The
BBU3910A neither supports a GBTS nor BBU interconnection (added in SRAN10.0).
15. After a separate-MPT multimode base station enabled with the CPRI MUX feature is
reconstructed into a co-MPT base station, the UBRIb or UBBPd serves as the converging
board if CPRI ports of the co-MPT base station carry GU/GL services. For details, see
CPRI MUX Feature Parameter Description in 3900 Series Base Station Product
Documentation.
Limitation on Transmission
1.
If the GBTS uses TDM or HDLC transmission (TDM over E1 for GTMU or other
transmission), change the TDM over E1 transmission to IP over E1 or IP over FE.
Otherwise, the co-MPT reconstruction is not supported.
2.
The conversion cannot be performed if a BSC pool is used and the transmission over the
Abis interface is used by different operators (this configuration is added in SRAN9.0).
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
520
3.
In the E1 backup scenario, if configuration data of the GBTS indicates that the primary
channel of the base station uses IP over E1 transmission and the secondary channel of the
base station uses IP over FE transmission, the tool cannot automatically identify this
scenario. In this situation, you need to assess the scenario before the reconstruction.
4.
5.
The tool does not support the reconstruction if the Ethernet port configured for a base
station is inconsistent with that actually used. For example, the IP address is configured
on an electrical port but the cable is connected to an optical port in actual use.
6.
The reconstruction cannot be performed if non-64 kbit/s timeslots have been monitored.
7.
8.
If the GBTS uses IP over FE/GE transmission (FE port on the GTMU), the GTMUb
conversion board does not support IP over FE/GE after reconstruction. (If separate
transmission was used before reconstruction, intermediate transmission needs to be
adjusted.) Assume that a base station deployed with both UMTS and LTE which use
separate transmission supporting IP over FE needs to be reconstructed into a co-MPT
base station which uses co-transmission supporting port sharing and IP over FE, and the
base station has UMTS and LTE inclusive route relationship and preferentially matches
the route of the non-reference mode (this route complies with the longest matching
principle or has the highest priority under the same length). In this scenario, you need to
configure the VLAN and route of the non-reference mode and reference mode for
transmission device. Otherwise, the OMCH and co-MPT reconstruction fail.
9.
Scenarios where IP addresses for GU and GL conflict are not considered for data
verification. If the IP addresses conflict, reconstruction fails.
10. For IPoE1-based GBTSs configured with the monitor timeslot, the monitor timeslot
configuration cannot be automatically converted for the co-MPT base stations. You need
to manually add the configuration of monitor timeslot after the reconstruction.
11. When converting base stations using DHCP servers, you are advised to convert base
stations configured on the same port of the base station controller at the same batch. If
one base station is not reconstructed together with other base stations, the base station
will obtain incorrect IP configuration data when it goes through the DHCP server-based
deployment procedure after a reset. As a result, the base station fails to start.
12. Co-MPT reconstruction restrictions on co-transmission are as follows:
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
a.
In the scenario where a GU base station uses co-IP transmission, the internal IP
address on the GSM side is on the same network segment as the default local IP
address. As a result, the generated data fails the verification. In addition, the tool for
converting the GBTS data to eGBTS data cannot identify such a scenario, and
therefore the tool used for co-MPT reconstruction from a separate-MPT GU base
station to a co-MPT GU base station does not support this scenario.
ggg.
Scenarios where BBUs are interconnected through two front panels are not
supported. If BBUs are interconnected through one front panel before co-MPT
reconstruction, the cable used for interconnection must be reserved. If a GTMU is
to be abandoned, BBU interconnection through either one or two front panels is not
supported.
hhh.
521
iii.
jjj.
Reconstruction from Ethernet trunk separate transmission to Ethernet trunk cotransmission is not supported.
kkk.
Reconstruction cannot be performed in UTRPc-, UTRP2-, or UTRP9-based cotransmission scenarios when GSM is involved in reconstruction. When a separateMPT UL base station uses UTRPc-based co-transmission, only the reference mode
provides transmission ports during reconstruction.
lll.
In the case of co-transmission through a backplane, the two ports of the board that
provides a co-transmission port are configured with device IP addresses. Therefore,
it is difficult to determine which port is the co-transmission port and this scenario is
not supported.
mmm. If
nnn.
ooo.
ppp.
IPsec is configured for the non-reference modes but not the reference mode.
qqq.
14. Co-MPT reconstruction from a separate-MPT multimode base station is not supported if
both Ethernet and Ethernet trunk are used.
15. Co-MPT reconstruction from a separate-MPT multimode base station is not supported if
LTE is not the reference mode and the two ports of the LMPT are used as optical or
electrical ports.
16. Co-MPT reconstruction from a separate-MPT multimode base station is not supported if
PA of the main control board of a non-reference mode is set to AUTO(Automatic
Detection) because whether the Ethernet port is an optical or electrical port is not clear.
You can query the value of PA using the LST ETHPORT command. In addition, CoMPT reconstruction from an LO base station is not supported if PA of the LMPT board
is set to AUTO(Automatic Detection).
17. If the E1/T1 ports on one board will work in two bearing modes, such as IP and ATM
bearing modes after reconstruction, co-MPT reconstruction is not supported.
18. Co-MPT reconstruction is not supported if conflicts in the VLANMAP MO exist (the
values of Next Hop IP are the same or the subnet of a base station contains that of
another) and the values of VLAN Group No. are different.
19. Co-MPT reconstruction is not supported if boards working in active/standby mode are
configured on multiple separate-MPT multimode base stations.
20. In scenarios where a separate-MPT multimode base station is to be reconstructed, only
one type of route, source route or destination route, must be used for both the reference
and non-reference modes. Otherwise, co-MPT reconstruction is not supported.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
522
21. The transmission port cannot be specified during reconstruction but can be specified
during transmission reconfiguration after reconstruction.
22. After the reconstruction, multiple next hop IP addresses, instead of one next hop IP
address, are used for the BTS maintenance plane, controller plane, and service plane.
Specifically, for the original GBTS, only one next hop IP address is used. If multiple
next hop IP addresses are required after the reconstruction, this configuration is not
supported by the tool. In this case, configure the route data after the reconstruction. The
following describes how to manually configure the route:
a.
If the next hop IP address of the BTS maintenance plane after the reconstruction is
different from the original next hop IP address, delete the original route to the IP
address of the U2000, and then run the ADD IPRT command to add a new route
and configure the actual next hop IP address.
rrr.
If the next hop IP address of the BTS control plane after the reconstruction is
different from the original next hop IP address, configure the route and next hop IP
address in the same way.
Note that the new next hop IP address planned for the BTS maintenance or control plane
must fall in the same network segment as the IP address of the Ethernet port configured
in the BTS parameter DEVIP. If they fall in different network segments, plan the IP
addresses of new BTS ports by running the ADD DEVIP command.
Limitation on Clock
1.
The reference clock planned by the customer is not included in the configuration data of
existing base stations.
2.
The reference clock planned by the customer supports only frequency synchronization,
but time synchronization is used for the configuration data of existing base stations. In
this case, it is recommended that the planned reference clock be adjusted to correct the
planned data before the co-MPT reconstruction.
3.
The reference clock planned by the customer does not support TOD clock cascading, but
TOD clock cascading data is included in the configuration data of existing base stations.
In this case, it is recommended that the reference clock be changed to a TOD clock to
correct the planned data or you run the RMV TOD command to modify the
configuration data of existing base stations.
4.
The reference clock planned by the customer does not support synchronous Ethernet
clock cascading, but synchronous Ethernet clock cascading data is included in the
configuration data of existing base stations. In this case, it is recommended that the
reference clock be changed to a synchronous Ethernet clock to correct the planned data
or you run the RMV SYNCETH command to modify the configuration data of existing
base stations.
5.
The BSC has been configured with the NTP server. The tool does not support the
reconstruction when the NTP uses encrypted authentication. In this case, re-configure the
encryption information after the BTS starts upon the configuration activation.
523
The GBTS must run a version no later than that of NodeB and eNodeB, and the mapping
relationships between these three base stations satisfy the software whitelist
requirements.
2.
Only the standalone CME supports the co-MPT reconstruction when a RAT is upgraded
separately. The online CME does not support such a reconstruction.
3.
When the independent RAT upgrade function is supported, the software whitelist
contains the mapping relationships about V/R/C/SPC versions. Therefore, such a coMPT reconstruction is supported when RATs differ in the SPC version, instead of the
SPH version.
4.
Base station software supports a disguised version. However, the name of the base
station conversion component released at the support website must have a true version. If
the name have a disguised version, unpredictable exceptions may occur during the coMPT reconstruction when a RAT is upgraded separately.
5.
If the reconstruction is performed in batches, the base stations with the same RAT must
have the RAT running the same version. If base stations with the same RAT have the
RAT running different version, they must be classified into different batches for
reconstruction.
Requirement
CPU
x86
2 GHz
Memory
2 GB
2000 MB
Requirement
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
524
Item
Requirement
Excel version
OS language
English
A maximum of 50 base stations can be reconstructed at a time, and therefore do not enter
data for more than 50 base stations in the reconstruction data planning file.
If License Share in BBU Carrier Pool is set to YES(Yes), run the MOD BTS
command to change the setting.
2.
If Cell Extension Type is set DualTS_ExtCell, run the MOD GCELL command to
change the setting.
3.
If Support BTS Local Switch is set to YES(Yes), run the SET BTSLSW command to
change the setting.
4.
5.
If NCH Occupy Block Number is set to a value other than 0, run the SET
GCELLGSMR command to change the setting.
6.
7.
8.
If EGPRS2-A is set to YES(YES), run the SET GCELLGPRS command to change the
setting.
9.
525
Convert the data of activated base station, cells and carriers only.
In the Ethernet OAM CC scenario, after the BTS is reconstructed into an eGBTS, run the
ACT CFMCC command to perform corresponding activation and check.
2.
Before the reconstruction, Ethernet OAM 802.1ag is configured for the GBTS, and the
MAC-based RMEP is configured for the equipment interconnected to the GBTS: After
the reconstruction, Ethernet ports for interconnection are configured for the UMPT
instead of the GTMU. Therefore, in the given scenario, after the reconstruction, the data
configuration of the equipment interconnected to the GBTS needs to be changed to
ensure that the configured MAC address is the MAC address of the Ethernet port on the
UMPT.
3.
After a GBTS is changed to an eGBTS, if the NTP protocol is required for the clock
synchronization, the reconstruction tool will by default use the NTP server used by the
BSC as the NTP server for the eGBTS. Therefore, the route from the NTP server to the
eGBTS must exist. Otherwise, you need to add one. If another NTP server is required by
the eGBTS after reconstruction, a new NTP address must be configured.
CTRLLNK: The scenario where no control link is configured for both main control
boards when inter-BBU separate-MPT is used for a dual-mode base station is not
supported. In addition, a control link can be added by running the ADD CTRLLNK
command.
2.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
526
3.
If both the primary and secondary modes have the same chain number under
RRUCHAIN, reassign a chain number to the secondary mode, that is, using the
maximum value among available values.
4.
If ALDs of both modes have the same device number, reassign a device number to the
secondary mode, that is, using the minimum value among available values.
5.
If the SRAN name after the reconstruction is not included in the reconstruction planning
file, the NE name of the primary mode will be used by default. However, the
reconstruction is not supported if the SRAN name is excluded and the NE name is blank.
In this case, the NE name can be configured by running the SET NENAME command.
6.
For ALDs of the primary and secondary modes, the vendor code, serial number, and
device name cannot be the same value except the value of null.
7.
If two sectors with different modes share the same antenna before the reconstruction,
combine the two sectors into one, using the parameters of the primary mode
preferentially, such as the sector number and sector name.
8.
The reconstruction cannot be performed if two baseband devices with different modes
share some of baseband processing units before the reconstruction. If two baseband
devices with different modes share the same baseband processing units before the
reconstruction, combine the two devices into one, using the parameters of the primary
mode preferentially.
9.
If DEVIP and ETHTRK are configured for the Ethernet, the configurations of the
primary mode will be used.
10. The OMCH configurations of the UMTS or LTE mode will be used to ensure the OMCH
connectivity in the scenario in GU or GL reconstruction scenarios.
11. For E1 backup, the network segments of the routes for the OMCH cannot overlap with
those of the routes for the user plane and data plane. If a route of the LTE mode can
reach U2000 as well as MME or SGW, users need to split this route into multiple routes.
The network segment of the destination IP address of the route to the U2000 cannot
contain the network segment of the route to the MME or SGW. For details about the
configurations, see Abis Transmission Backup. (You can obtain this document from
GBSS Feature Documentation on Hedex. On the GBSS Feature Documentation web
page, choose Description > Reliability > Abis Transmission Backup from the
navigation tree.). The OMCH configurations will not be combined. The configurations
related to E1 backup in UDPSESSION and GTRANSPARA will be combined.
12. For RRUs serving one GSM cell and two UMTS/LTE sectors, configure the RRU for
one UMTS/LTE sector before the combination.
If multiple default routes for the IPRT exist, the default route of the primary mode will
be used. Users need to analyze the impact and solve the issue.
2.
The QoS-related configurations of the primary mode will be used after the
reconstruction. As a result, the QoS of the secondary mode will be affected. After the
reconstruction, a warning will be generated. The warning indicates the configurations of
each mode before the reconstruction, and users need to determine whether the QoSrelated configurations (such as DIFPRI and DSCPMAP) need to be modified.
3.
The tool cannot automatically convert interconnected sectors through two systems into
one sector in one system.
4.
If the maintenance IP of GBTS is the same as 192.168 network segment, need to replan
IP address. Otherwise the maintenance IP of GBTS and default maintenance IP of UMPT
are in the same segment caused co-MPT reconstruction failed.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
527
5.
The rule for merging the transmission configuration data (the PACKETFILTER MO) is
as follows: all the PACKETFILTER MOs for baseline RAT and non-baseline RAT and
set the filter switch in the EPGROUP MO to disable. If users need packet filtering after
the Co-MPT reconstruction, the users manually configure the filter switch.
6.
sss.
IP over FE is used.
ttt.
2.
3.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
If the base station before reconstruction uses E1/T1 transmission (including E1/T1
over IP or E1/T1 over ATM), the UMPTe cannot serve as the main control board for
the co-MPT base station after reconstruction because the UMPTe does not support
E1/T1 transmission.
If the UMPTe serves as the main control board for the co-MPT base station after
reconstruction, the main control boards (including WMPT and LMPT) before
reconstruction are abandoned, and the main control board (UMPTa/b) before
reconstruction is retained and serves as the signaling extension board for the
UMPTe.
From SRAN11.1 onwards, hybrid-MPT base stations can be reconstructed. That is, the
co-MPT base station and separate-MPT base station can be reconstructed into a new coMPT base station. This type of reconstruction has the following constraints:
a.
The separate-MPT base station and co-MPT base station before reconstruction
cannot have the same NE types. For example, in the case of G[G*U]->[G*U], G
indicates the separate-MPT base station and G*U the co-MPT base station before
reconstruction.
uuu.
The reference mode must be the mode deployed on the co-MPT base station instead
of the separate-MPT base station.
vvv.
The following reconstruction scenarios are not supported: Two or more co-MPT
base stations are involved before reconstruction; The co-MPT base station to be
reconstructed is an eGBTS.
In SRAN11.0 and earlier versions, the GTMUc supports only the legacy scenarios and
does not support SingleOM co-MPT or evolution mode. Therefore, the GTMUc serves
Huawei Proprietary and Confidential
Copyright Huawei
Technologies Co., Ltd.
528
as a GTMUa during the reconstruction. In SRAN11.1 and later versions, the GTMUc
supports SingleOM and evolution modes. Therefore, the GTMUc serves as a GTMUb
during the reconstruction.
Before
Reconstruc
tion
After
Reconstructio
n
Main
Contro
l
Board
Trans
missi
on
Main
Control
Board
Trans
missio
n
GTM
Ub
IPoE
1
GTMUb
(evolved)
+UMPT_G
IPoE1
GTM
Ub
IPoF
E
GTMUb
(evolved)
+UMPT_G
IPoFE
GTM
Ub
E1
back
up
GTMUb
(evolved)
+UMPT_G
E1
backup
GTM
Ua/b
IPoE
1
GTMU
(abandone
d)
+UMPT_G
IPoE1
GTM
Ua/b
IPoF
E
GTMU
(abandone
d)
+UMPT_G
IPoFE
GTM
Ua/b
E1
back
up
GTMUb
(abandone
d)
+UMPT_G
E1
backup
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Before
Reconstruct
ion
After
Reconstructio
n
Main
Contr
ol
Board
Main
Control
Board
Trans
missio
n
Trans
missio
n
529
WMP
T
IPoFE/
IPoE1/
ATM/
ATM&
IPoFE
UMPT_U
IPoFE/
IPoE1/
ATM/
ATM&
IPoFE
UMPT
_U
IPoFE/
IPoE1/
ATM/
ATM&
IPoFE
UMPT_U
IPoFE/
IPoE1/
ATM/
ATM&
IPoFE
Before
Reconstruct
ion
After
Reconstructio
n
Main
Contr
ol
Board
Trans
missio
n
Main
Control
Board
Trans
missio
n
LMPT
IPoFE
UMPT_L
IPoFE
UMPT
_L
IPoFE
UMPT_L
IPoFE
Before
Reconstruction
After
Reconstruction
Main
Contr
ol
Board
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issio
n
UM
TS
Tran
smis
sion
Main
Contr
ol
Board
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tran
smiss
ion
GTM
Ub+W
MPT/
UMP
T_U
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
GTM
Ub
(evolv
ed)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
530
GTM
Ub+W
MPT/
UMP
T_U
IPo
FE
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
GTM
Ub
(evolv
ed)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
FE
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
1. If separate transmission is
adopted for GSM and UMTS
before the reconstruction, this
transmission mode will still be
adopted after the reconstruction.
GTM
Ua/b+
WMP
T/UM
PT_U
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE
GTM
Ua/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE
GTM
Ua/b+
WMP
T/UM
PT_U
IPo
FE
IPoF
E/IP
oE1/
ATM
/AT
M&I
PoFE
GTM
Ua/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
FE
IPoF
E/IPo
E1/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
5
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
GTM
IPo
IPoE
GTM
IPo
IPoE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
531
Ub+
UMP
T_U
E1
1/IPo
FE/G
E/AT
M/A
TM
&IPo
FE/G
E
Ub
(evolv
ed)
+UMP
T_GU
E1
IPo
FE/
GE
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/G
E/AT
M/A
TM
&IPo
FE/G
E
GTM
Ub
(evolv
ed)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/G
E
IPoF
E/GE
/IPo
E1/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE/G
E
Note:
U is a
coMPT
base
station
.
6
GTM
Ub+
UMP
T_U
Note:
U is a
coMPT
base
station
.
GTM
Ua/b+
UMP
T_U
Note:
U is a
coMPT
base
station
.
GTM
Ua/b+
UMP
T_U
Note:
U is a
coMPT
base
station
.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPo
FE/
GE
1/IPo
FE/G
E/AT
M/A
TM&
IPoF
E/GE
scenario:
IPo
FE/
GE
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/G
E/AT
M/A
TM&
IPoF
E/GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
GTM
Ua/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
E1
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/G
E
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
GTM
Ua/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GU
IPo
E1
IPoF
E/GE
/IPoE
1/AT
M/A
TM&
IPoF
E/GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
G&[U]->[G*U]
G&[U]->[G*U]
G&[U]->[G*U]
G&[U]->[G*U]
532
Note 1: Assume that GSM and UMTS use IP over FE transmission and separate transmission
before reconstruction. If GSM and UMTS data are transmitted from Ethernet ports of
different numbers on different boards before reconstruction, the GSM and UMTS data will be
transmitted from different Ethernet ports after reconstruction; if GSM and UMTS data are
transmitted from Ethernet ports of the same number on different boards before reconstruction,
the GSM and UMTS data will be transmitted from the same Ethernet port after reconstruction.
Before
Reconstructio
n
After
Reconstruction
Main
Cont
rol
Boar
d
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issio
n
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
Main
Contr
ol
Board
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issio
n
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
GTM
Ub+L
MPT/
UMP
T_L
IPoE
1/
IPo
FE
GTMU
b
(evolve
d)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoE
1/
IPo
FE
GTMU
b
(evolve
d)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoF
E
GTMU
a/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoE
1/
GTM
Ub+L
MPT/
UMP
T_L
GTM
Ua/b
+LM
PT/U
MPT
_L
E1
back
up
IPoF
E
IPoE
1/
E1
back
up
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
E1
back
up
2. The GSM transmission uses E1
backup transmission.
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
E1
back
up
533
LTE is UBBP.
GTM
Ua/b
+LM
PT/U
MPT
_L
IPoF
E
IPo
FE
GTMU
a/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoF
E
IPo
FE
5
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
GTM
IPoE
IPo
GTMU
IPoE
IPo
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
534
Ub+
UMP
T_L
Note:
L is a
coMPT
base
statio
n.
6
GTM
Ub+
UMP
T_L
1/
FE/
GE
b
(evolve
d)
+UMP
T_GL
1/
IPoF
E/G
E
IPo
FE/
GE
GTMU
b
(evolve
d)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoE
1/
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
E1
back
up
Note:
L is a
coMPT
base
statio
n.
7
GTM
Ua/b
+UM
PT_L
Note:
L is a
coMPT
base
statio
n.
GTM
Ua/b
+UM
PT_L
Note:
L is a
coMPT
base
statio
n.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
E1
back
up
IPoF
E/G
E
FE/
GE
scenario:
IPoF
E/G
E
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
GTMU
a/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoE
1/
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
GTMU
a/b
(aband
oned)
+UMP
T_GL
IPoF
E/G
E
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
E1
back
up
E1
back
up
G&[L]->[G*L]
G&[L]->[G*L]
G&[L]->[G*L]
G&[L]->[G*L]
535
Note 1: Assume that GSM and LTE use IP over FE transmission and separate transmission
before reconstruction. If GSM and LTE data are transmitted from Ethernet ports of different
numbers on different boards before reconstruction, the GSM and LTE data will be transmitted
from different Ethernet ports after reconstruction; if GSM and LTE data are transmitted from
Ethernet ports of the same number on different boards before reconstruction, the GSM and
LTE data will be transmitted from the same Ethernet port after reconstruction.
Before
Reconstruction
After
Reconstruction
Main
Contr
ol
Board
UMT
S
Tran
smiss
ion
LTE
Tra
nsm
issio
n
Main
Cont
rol
Boar
d
UMT
S
Trans
missio
n
LTE
Tra
nsm
issio
n
WMP
T/UM
PT_U
+LMP
T/UM
PT_L
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
IPoF
E
UMP
T_U
L+L
MPT
(evol
ved)
IPoE1
/IPoF
E/AT
M/AT
M&IP
oFE
IPoF
E
Or
WMP
T (inpositi
on
but
not
used)
+UM
PT_U
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
536
UMP
T_U+
UMP
T_L
UMP
T_U+
LMPT
or
WMP
T+U
MPT_
L
IPoE
1/IPo
FE/A
TM/
ATM
&IPo
FE
IPoF
E
UMP
T_U+
UMP
T_L
Note:
Either
U with
a
UMP
T_U
or L
with a
UMP
T_L is
a coMPT
base
station
.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Note
2
IPoE IPoF
1/IPo E/G
FE/G E
E/AT
M/AT
M&I
PoFE
/GE
UMP
T_U
L+L
MPT
(evol
ved)
IPoE IPoF
1/IPo E/G
FE/G E
E/AT
M/AT
M&I
PoFE
/GE
UMP
T_U
L+U
MPT
_UL
Note:
U with
a
UMP
T_U
and L
with a
UMP
T_L
are
both
coMPT
base
station
s.
4
UMP
T_U
L+U
MPT
_UL
or
UMP
T_U
L+W
MPT
(evol
ved)
IPoE1
/IPoF
E/AT
M/AT
M&IP
oFE
IPoF
E
IPoE1
/IPoF
E/GE/
ATM/
ATM
&IPoF
E/GE
IPoF
E/G
E
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
IPoE1
/IPoF
E/GE/
ATM/
ATM
&IPoF
E/GE
IPoF
E/G
E
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
537
Note 1: Assume that UMTS and LTE use IP over FE separate transmission before
reconstruction. If UMTS and LTE services are transmitted from Ethernet ports of different
numbers before reconstruction, the UMTS and LTE services will be transmitted still from
different Ethernet ports after reconstruction; if UMTS and LTE services are transmitted from
Ethernet ports of the same number before reconstruction, the UMTS and LTE services will be
transmitted from the same Ethernet port after reconstruction.
Note 2: If the main control boards of UMTS and LTE are both UMPT of the same type before
reconstruction, the two UMPTs can work in active/standby mode after the UMTS and LTE
co-MPT reconstruction. If the two UMPTs are of different types, they cannot work in
active/standby mode, and then the UMPT with lower specifications will be abandoned.
Before
Reconstruction
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issio
n
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
GT
MU
b
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
+U
MP
T_U
L
GT
MU
b
+U
MP
T_U
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
After
Reconstruction
G&[U*L]->[G*U*L]
G&[U*L]->[G*U*L]
538
GT
MU
a/b
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
WM
PT+
UM
PT_
GL
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
W
MP
T
(inposi
tion
but
not
use
d)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
UM
PT_
U+
UM
PT_
GL
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
IPo
FE/
GE
UM
PT_
GU
L+
UM
PT_
GU
L
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
+U
MP
T_U
L
GT
MU
a/b
+U
MP
T_U
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
G&[U*L]->[G*U*L]
G&[U*L]->[G*U*L]
U&[G*L]->[G*U*L]
U&[G*L]->[G*U*L]
539
GE
7
GE
LM
PT+
UM
PT_
GU
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
LM
PT
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
UM
PT_
L+U
MP
T_G
U
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
UM
PT_
GU
L+
UM
PT_
GU
L
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT
reconstruction scenario:
L&[G*U]->[G*U*L]
L&[G*U]->[G*U*L]
Note 1: Assume that UMTS and LTE use IP over FE separate transmission before
reconstruction. If UMTS and LTE services are transmitted from Ethernet ports of different
numbers before reconstruction, the UMTS and LTE services will be transmitted still from
different Ethernet ports after reconstruction; if UMTS and LTE services are transmitted from
Ethernet ports of the same number before reconstruction, the UMTS and LTE services will be
transmitted from the same Ethernet port after reconstruction.
Note 2: If the main control boards of UMTS and LTE are both UMPT of the same type before
reconstruction, the two UMPTs can work in active/standby mode after the UMTS and LTE
co-MPT reconstruction. If the two UMPTs are of different types, they cannot work in
active/standby mode, and then the UMPT with lower specifications will be abandoned.
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
Before
Reconstruction
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
After
Reconstruction
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issio
n
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
540
Mo
de
1
GT
MU
b+
WM
PT/
UM
PT_
U
IPo
E1
UM
PT_
L
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
1. If separate transmission
is adopted for GSM,
UMTS, and LTE before the
reconstruction, it will still
be adopted after the
reconstruction no matter
whether UCIU-based BBU
interconnection or UMPTbased BBU interconnection
is used.
UM
PT_
GU
L
2
GT
MU
b+
WM
PT/
UM
PT_
U
UM
PT_
L
IPo
FE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
UM
PT_
GU
L
541
GT
MU
a/b+
WM
PT/
UM
PT_
U
IPo
E1
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
L
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
GU
L
GT
MU
a/b+
UM
PT_
U
UM
PT_
L
IPo
FE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
FE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPo
FE
GU
L
Before
Reconstruction
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
Mo
de
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issio
n
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
GT
MU
b+L
MP
T/U
MP
T_L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
U
After
Reconstruction
UM
PT_
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
543
GT
MU
b+L
MP
T/U
MP
T_L
UM
PT_
U
IPo
FE
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
FE
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
544
GT
MU
a/b+
LM
PT/
UM
PT_
L
UM
PT_
U
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E
IPo
FE
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
FE/
AT
M/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
GU
L
IPo
FE
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
545
GT
MU
a/b+
LM
PT/
UM
PT_
L
UM
PT_
U
IPo
FE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
FE
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
UM
PT_
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPo
FE
546
547
abandoned).
Before
Reconstruction
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issio
n
Mai
n
Con
trol
Boa
rd
GS
M
Tra
nsm
issi
on
UM
TS
Tra
nsm
issi
on
LT
E
Tra
nsm
issi
on
GT
MU
b+L
MP
T/U
MP
T_L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
FE/I
PoE
1/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE
IPo
FE
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
UM
PT_
U
After
Reconstruction
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
G&[U*L]+[U*L]>[G*U*L]+[G*U*L]
UM
PT_
GU
L
2
BB
U0:
GT
MU
b+U
MP
T_
UL
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
UL
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
BB
U0:
GT
MU
b
(evo
lved
)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
G&[U*L]+[U*L]>[G*U*L]+[G*U*L]
548
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
GU
L
3
BB
U0:
GT
MU
a/b+
UM
PT_
UL
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
UL
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
BB
U0:
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
IPo
E1/
E1
bac
kup
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
Hybird-MPT reconstruction
scenario:
G&[U*L]+[U*L]>[G*U*L]+[G*U*L]
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
GU
L
4
BB
U0:
GT
MU
a/b+
UM
PT_
UL
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
UL
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
E1/I
PoF
E/G
E/A
TM/
AT
M&
IPo
FE/
GE
IPo
FE/
GE
BB
U0:
GT
MU
a/G
TM
Ub
(aba
ndo
ned)
+U
MP
T_
GU
L
G&[U*L]+[U*L]>[G*U*L]+[G*U*L]
BB
U1:
UM
PT_
GU
L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
549
G, UL -> G*U*L
GTMUb evolution
GTMUa/GTMUb (abandoned)
GTMUb evolution
GTMUa/GTMUb (abandoned)
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
550
Scenario No.
GTMUb evolution
GTMUa/GTMUb (abandoned)
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
551
Scenario No.
U, L -> U*L
G, U -> G*U
GTMUb evolution
GTMUa/GTMUb (abandoned)
G, L -> G*L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
GTMUb evolution:
552
Scenario No.
GTMUa/GTMUb (abandoned)
BBU1 Before
Reconstruction
BBU2 Before
Reconstruction
BBUs Before
Reconstruction
(Two Combined
into One)
G, UL ->
G*U*L
GBTS
Co-MPT NodeB,
separate-MPT
eNodeB
GBTS
Separate-MPT
NodeB, co-MPT
eNodeB
GBTS
Co-MPT UL base
station
GBTS, co-MPT
NodeB
Separate-MPT
eNodeB
GU, L ->
G*U*L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
553
Scenario
BBU1 Before
Reconstruction
BBU2 Before
Reconstruction
BBUs Before
Reconstruction
(Two Combined
into One)
Co-MPT eNodeB
Co-MPT GU base
station
Separate-MPT
eNodeB
GBTS, co-MPT
eNodeB
Separate-MPT NodeB
Co-MPT NodeB
Co-MPT GL base
station
Separate-MPT NodeB
Co-MPT NodeB
Separate-MPT
eNodeB
Co-MPT UL base
station
Separate-MPT
NodeB
Co-MPT eNodeB
Co-MPT UL base
station
G, U -> G*U
GBTS
Co-MPT NodeB
Co-MPT GU base
station
G, L -> G*L
GBTS
Co-MPT eNodeB
Co-MPT GL base
station
GL, U ->
G*U*L
U, L -> U*L
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
554
13
Issue 01 (2015-12-30)
555